]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo
daily update
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
8a037dd7 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7
EZ
56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7
EZ
89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
8a037dd7 121Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 151* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
161* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 163* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
164* Index:: Index
165@end menu
166
6c0e9fb3 167@end ifnottex
c906108c 168
449f3b6c 169@contents
449f3b6c 170
6d2ebf8b 171@node Summary
c906108c
SS
172@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181@itemize @bullet
182@item
183Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185@item
186Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188@item
189Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191@item
192Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194@end itemize
195
cce74817 196You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 197For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
198For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
db034ac5 200@c OBSOLETE @cindex Chill
cce74817 201@cindex Modula-2
db034ac5
AC
202Support for Modula-2
203@c OBSOLETE and Chill
204is partial. For information on Modula-2, see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
205@c OBSOLETE For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 206
cce74817
JM
207@cindex Pascal
208Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211syntax.
c906108c 212
c906108c
SS
213@cindex Fortran
214@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 215it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 216underscore.
c906108c 217
c906108c
SS
218@menu
219* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
220* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
221@end menu
222
6d2ebf8b 223@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
224@unnumberedsec Free software
225
5d161b24 226@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
227General Public License
228(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
229program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
230freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
231the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
232Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
233Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
234
235Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
236you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
237from anyone else.
238
2666264b 239@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
240
241The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
242the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
243include with the free software. Many of our most important
244programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
245texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
246when an important free software package does not come with a free
247manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
248gaps today.
249
250Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
251normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
252authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
253copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
254them from the free software world.
255
256That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
257from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
258manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
259only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
260contract to make it non-free.
261
262Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
263price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
264charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
265Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
266problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
267are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
268modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
269
270The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
271free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
272commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
273accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
274
275Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
276When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
277are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
278provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
279manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
280a changed version of the program is not really available to our
281community.
282
283Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
284acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
285author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
286authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
287to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
288may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
289with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
290are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
291of the manual.
292
293However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
294content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
295media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
296obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
297manual to replace it.
298
299Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
300lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
301free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
302the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
303realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
304the free software community.
305
306If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
307the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
308license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
309don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
310will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
311option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
312what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
313try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 314is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
315
316You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
317manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
318copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
319improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
320at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
321and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
322Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
323have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
324
325The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
326published by other publishers, at
327@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
328
6d2ebf8b 329@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
330@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
331
332Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
333other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
334development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
335of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
336to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
337file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
338blow-by-blow account.
339
340Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
341
342@quotation
343@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
344or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
345omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
346@end quotation
347
348So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
349particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
350releases:
299ffc64 351Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
352Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
353Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
354Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
355Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
356Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
357John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
358Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
359and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
360
361Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
362Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
363
b37052ae
EZ
364Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
365in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
366Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
367demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
368much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 369
b37052ae 370@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
371object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
372Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
373
374David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
375the original support for encapsulated COFF.
376
96c405b3 377Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
378
379Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
380Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
381support.
382Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
383Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
384Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
385David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
386Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
387Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
388Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
389Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
390Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
391Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
392Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
393Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
394Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
395Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
396Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
397
398Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
399
400Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401libraries.
402
403Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404about several machine instruction sets.
405
406Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412command-line editing and command history.
413
7a292a7a
SS
414Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 416
5d161b24 417Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 418He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 419symbols.
c906108c
SS
420
421Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
422Super-H processors.
423
424NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
426Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
427
428Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
429
430Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
431
96a2c332 432Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
433
434Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
435watchpoints.
436
437Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
438
439Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
440
441Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 442nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
443
444The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
445support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 446(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
447compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
448John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
449Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
450information in this manual.
451
b37052ae
EZ
452DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
453Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
454
96a2c332
SS
455Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
456development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
457fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
458Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
459Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
460Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
461Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
462addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
463JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
464Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
465Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
466Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
467Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
468Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
469Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 470
e2e0bcd1
JB
471Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
472Hat.
c906108c 473
6d2ebf8b 474@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
475@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
476
477You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
478However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
479debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
480
481@iftex
482In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
483to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
484@end iftex
485
486@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
487@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
488
489One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
490processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
491quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
492definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
493session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
494then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
495same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
496@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
497procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
498
499@smallexample
500$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
501$ @b{./m4}
502@b{define(foo,0000)}
503
504@b{foo}
5050000
506@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
507
508@b{bar}
5090000
510@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
511
512@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
513@b{baz}
514@b{C-d}
515m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
516@end smallexample
517
518@noindent
519Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
520
c906108c
SS
521@smallexample
522$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
523@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
524@c FIXME... format to come out better.
525@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 526 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 527 the conditions.
5d161b24 528There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
529 for details.
530
531@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
532(@value{GDBP})
533@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
534
535@noindent
536@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
537rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
538We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
539that examples fit in this manual.
540
541@smallexample
542(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
543@end smallexample
544
545@noindent
546We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
547Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
548@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
549@code{break} command.
550
551@smallexample
552(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
553Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
554@end smallexample
555
556@noindent
557Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
558control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
559subroutine, the program runs as usual:
560
561@smallexample
562(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
563Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
564@b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566@b{foo}
5670000
568@end smallexample
569
570@noindent
571To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
572suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
573context where it stops.
574
575@smallexample
576@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
577
5d161b24 578Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
579 at builtin.c:879
580879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
581@end smallexample
582
583@noindent
584Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
585the next line of the current function.
586
587@smallexample
588(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
589882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
590 : nil,
591@end smallexample
592
593@noindent
594@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
595by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
596@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
597subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
598
599@smallexample
600(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
601set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
602 at input.c:530
603530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
604@end smallexample
605
606@noindent
607The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
608suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
609shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
610command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
611in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
612stack frame for each active subroutine.
613
614@smallexample
615(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
616#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
617 at input.c:530
5d161b24 618#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
619 at builtin.c:882
620#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
621#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
622 at macro.c:71
623#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
624#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
625@end smallexample
626
627@noindent
628We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
629times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
630falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
631
632@smallexample
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6340x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
635(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6360x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
637def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
638(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
639536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
640 : xstrdup(rq);
641(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
643@end smallexample
644
645@noindent
646The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
647@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
648and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
649(@code{print}) to see their values.
650
651@smallexample
652(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
653$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
654(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
655$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
656@end smallexample
657
658@noindent
659@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
660To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
661surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
662
663@smallexample
664(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
665533 xfree(rquote);
666534
667535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
668 : xstrdup (lq);
669536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
670 : xstrdup (rq);
671537
672538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
673539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
674540 @}
675541
676542 void
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
681@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
682
683@smallexample
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
687540 @}
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
689$3 = 9
690(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
691$4 = 7
692@end smallexample
693
694@noindent
695That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
696@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
697@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
698the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
699any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
700assignments.
701
702@smallexample
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
704$5 = 7
705(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
706$6 = 9
707@end smallexample
708
709@noindent
710Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
711@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
712executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
713example that caused trouble initially:
714
715@smallexample
716(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
717Continuing.
718
719@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
720
721baz
7220000
723@end smallexample
724
725@noindent
726Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
727problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
728lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
729
730@smallexample
731@b{C-d}
732Program exited normally.
733@end smallexample
734
735@noindent
736The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
737indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
738session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
739
740@smallexample
741(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
742@end smallexample
c906108c 743
6d2ebf8b 744@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
745@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
746
747This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 748The essentials are:
c906108c 749@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 750@item
53a5351d 751type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 752@item
c906108c
SS
753type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
754@end itemize
755
756@menu
757* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
758* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
759* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
760@end menu
761
6d2ebf8b 762@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
763@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
764
c906108c
SS
765Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
766@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
767
768You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
769to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
770
c906108c
SS
771The command-line options described here are designed
772to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 773options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
774
775The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
776specifying an executable program:
777
474c8240 778@smallexample
c906108c 779@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 780@end smallexample
c906108c 781
c906108c
SS
782@noindent
783You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
784specified:
785
474c8240 786@smallexample
c906108c 787@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 788@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
789
790You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
791to debug a running process:
792
474c8240 793@smallexample
c906108c 794@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 795@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
796
797@noindent
798would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
799named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
800
c906108c 801Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
802complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
803debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
804``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
805will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 806
aa26fa3a
TT
807You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
808executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
809option processing.
474c8240 810@smallexample
aa26fa3a 811gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 812@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
813This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
814@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
815
96a2c332 816You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
817@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
818
819@smallexample
820@value{GDBP} -silent
821@end smallexample
822
823@noindent
824You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
825options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
826
827@noindent
828Type
829
474c8240 830@smallexample
c906108c 831@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 832@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
833
834@noindent
835to display all available options and briefly describe their use
836(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
837
838All options and command line arguments you give are processed
839in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
840@samp{-x} option is used.
841
842
843@menu
c906108c
SS
844* File Options:: Choosing files
845* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
846@end menu
847
6d2ebf8b 848@node File Options
c906108c
SS
849@subsection Choosing files
850
2df3850c 851When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
852specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
853the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
854@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
855first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
856equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
857second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
858equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
859If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
860first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
861to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
862a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 863prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
864
865If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
866such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
867argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
868
869Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
870following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
871them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
872(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
873than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
874
d700128c
EZ
875@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
876@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
877@c it.
878
c906108c
SS
879@table @code
880@item -symbols @var{file}
881@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
882@cindex @code{--symbols}
883@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
884Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
885
886@item -exec @var{file}
887@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
888@cindex @code{--exec}
889@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
890Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
891and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
892
893@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 894@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
895Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
896file.
897
c906108c
SS
898@item -core @var{file}
899@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--core}
901@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 902Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
903
904@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
905@item -pid @var{number}
906@itemx -p @var{number}
907@cindex @code{--pid}
908@cindex @code{-p}
909Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
910If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
911file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
912
913@item -command @var{file}
914@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
915@cindex @code{--command}
916@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
917Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
918Files,, Command files}.
919
920@item -directory @var{directory}
921@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
922@cindex @code{--directory}
923@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
924Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
925
c906108c
SS
926@item -m
927@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
928@cindex @code{--mapped}
929@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
930@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
931supported on all systems.}@*
932If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 933system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
934to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
935program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 936called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
937Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
938and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
939the symbol table from the executable program.
940
941The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
942is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
943table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 944
c906108c
SS
945@item -r
946@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
947@cindex @code{--readnow}
948@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
949Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
950the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
951This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 952
c906108c
SS
953@end table
954
2df3850c 955You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 956order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
957information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
958on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
959but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 960
474c8240 961@smallexample
2df3850c 962gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 963@end smallexample
c906108c 964
6d2ebf8b 965@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
966@subsection Choosing modes
967
968You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
969batch mode or quiet mode.
970
971@table @code
972@item -nx
973@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
974@cindex @code{--nx}
975@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 976Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
977@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
978options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
979files}.
c906108c
SS
980
981@item -quiet
d700128c 982@itemx -silent
c906108c 983@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
984@cindex @code{--quiet}
985@cindex @code{--silent}
986@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
987``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
988messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
989
990@item -batch
d700128c 991@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
992Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
993command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
994initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
995nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
996in the command files.
997
2df3850c
JM
998Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
999example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1000make this more useful, the message
c906108c 1001
474c8240 1002@smallexample
c906108c 1003Program exited normally.
474c8240 1004@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1005
1006@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1007(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1008@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1009mode.
1010
1011@item -nowindows
1012@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1013@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1014@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1015``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1016(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1017interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1018
1019@item -windows
1020@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1021@cindex @code{--windows}
1022@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1023If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1024used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1025
1026@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1027@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1028Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1029instead of the current directory.
1030
c906108c
SS
1031@item -fullname
1032@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1033@cindex @code{--fullname}
1034@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1035@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1036subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1037number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1038displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1039recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1040the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1041and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1042@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1043frame.
c906108c 1044
d700128c
EZ
1045@item -epoch
1046@cindex @code{--epoch}
1047The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1048@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1049routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1050separate window.
1051
1052@item -annotate @var{level}
1053@cindex @code{--annotate}
1054This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1055effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1056(@pxref{Annotations}).
1057Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1058together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1059types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1060@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1061maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1062
1063@item -async
1064@cindex @code{--async}
1065Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1066@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1067special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1068commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1069run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1070MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1071suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1072control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1073(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1074operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1075yet.)
1076@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1077@c should be removed.
1078
1079When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1080uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1081@samp{-noasync} option.
1082
1083@item -noasync
1084@cindex @code{--noasync}
1085Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1086
aa26fa3a
TT
1087@item --args
1088@cindex @code{--args}
1089Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1090executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1091This option stops option processing.
1092
2df3850c
JM
1093@item -baud @var{bps}
1094@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1095@cindex @code{--baud}
1096@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1097Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1098interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1099
1100@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1101@itemx -t @var{device}
1102@cindex @code{--tty}
1103@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1104Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1105@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1106
53a5351d 1107@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1108@item -tui
1109@cindex @code{--tui}
1110Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1111The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1112showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1113(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1114Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1115(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1116
1117@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1118@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1119@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1120@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1121@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1122@c systems.
1123
d700128c
EZ
1124@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1125@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1126Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1127program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1128communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1129
1130@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1131@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1132@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1133@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1134
1135@item -write
1136@cindex @code{--write}
1137Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139(@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141@item -statistics
1142@cindex @code{--statistics}
1143This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146@item -version
1147@cindex @code{--version}
1148This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
c906108c
SS
1151@end table
1152
6d2ebf8b 1153@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1154@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158@table @code
1159@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1160@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1161@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162@itemx q
1163To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167error code.
c906108c
SS
1168@end table
1169
1170@cindex interrupt
1171An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175until a time when it is safe.
1176
c906108c
SS
1177If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1182@section Shell commands
1183
1184If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188@table @code
1189@kindex shell
1190@cindex shell escape
1191@item shell @var{command string}
1192Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1193If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1194shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1196@end table
1197
1198The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200@value{GDBN}:
1201
1202@table @code
1203@kindex make
1204@cindex calling make
1205@item make @var{make-args}
1206Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208@end table
1209
6d2ebf8b 1210@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1211@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219@menu
1220* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221* Completion:: Command completion
1222* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223@end menu
1224
6d2ebf8b 1225@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1226@section Command syntax
1227
1228A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1233with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1234
1235@cindex abbreviation
1236@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1245@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1246A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1247repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1248will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250repeat.
1251
1252The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
41afff9a 1262@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1263@cindex comment
1264Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266Files,,Command files}).
1267
88118b3a
TT
1268@cindex repeating command sequences
1269@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273for editing.
1274
6d2ebf8b 1275@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1276@section Command completion
1277
1278@cindex completion
1279@cindex word completion
1280@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
474c8240 1302@smallexample
c906108c 1303(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1305
1306@noindent
1307You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322example:
1323
474c8240 1324@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1325(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1327make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328make_abs_section make_function_type
1329make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1331make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1334
1335@noindent
1336After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338command.
1339
1340If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1341can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1342means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1343key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1344one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@cindex quotes in commands
1347@cindex completion of quoted strings
1348Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1349parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1353
c906108c 1354The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1355name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1365
474c8240 1366@smallexample
96a2c332 1367(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1368bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1370@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1371
1372In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375place:
1376
474c8240 1377@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1378(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1381@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1382
1383@noindent
1384In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
d4f3574e 1388For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1389expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1390overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1391see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1392
1393
6d2ebf8b 1394@node Help
c906108c
SS
1395@section Getting help
1396@cindex online documentation
1397@kindex help
1398
5d161b24 1399You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1400using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402@table @code
41afff9a 1403@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1404@item help
1405@itemx h
1406You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410(@value{GDBP}) help
1411List of classes of commands:
1412
2df3850c 1413aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1414breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1415data -- Examining data
c906108c 1416files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1417internals -- Maintenance commands
1418obscure -- Obscure features
1419running -- Running the program
1420stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1421status -- Status inquiries
1422support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1423tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
c906108c 1425user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1426
5d161b24 1427Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1428commands in that class.
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1430documentation.
1431Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432(@value{GDBP})
1433@end smallexample
96a2c332 1434@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1435
1436@item help @var{class}
1437Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441@smallexample
1442(@value{GDBP}) help status
1443Status inquiries.
1444
1445List of commands:
1446
1447@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1449info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
c906108c 1453
5d161b24 1454Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1455documentation.
1456Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457(@value{GDBP})
1458@end smallexample
1459
1460@item help @var{command}
1461With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
6837a0a2
DB
1464@kindex apropos
1465@item apropos @var{args}
1466The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470@smallexample
1471apropos reload
1472@end smallexample
1473
b37052ae
EZ
1474@noindent
1475results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1476
1477@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1478@c @group
1479set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1484@end smallexample
1485
c906108c
SS
1486@kindex complete
1487@item complete @var{args}
1488The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492@smallexample
1493complete i
1494@end smallexample
1495
1496@noindent results in:
1497
1498@smallexample
1499@group
2df3850c
JM
1500if
1501ignore
c906108c
SS
1502info
1503inspect
c906108c
SS
1504@end group
1505@end smallexample
1506
1507@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508@end table
1509
1510In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517@c @group
1518@table @code
1519@kindex info
41afff9a 1520@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1521@item info
1522This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527@w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529@kindex set
1530@item set
5d161b24 1531You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1532@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533@code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535@kindex show
1536@item show
5d161b24 1537In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1538@value{GDBN} itself.
1539You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544@kindex info set
1545To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551@end table
1552@c @end group
1553
1554Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex show version
1559@cindex version number
1560@item show version
1561Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1562information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1567variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1568The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1570
1571@kindex show copying
1572@item show copying
1573Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575@kindex show warranty
1576@item show warranty
2df3850c 1577Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1578if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1579
c906108c
SS
1580@end table
1581
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Running
c906108c
SS
1583@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1587
1588You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1592
1593@menu
1594* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1596* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1598
1599* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1603
1604* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606@end menu
1607
6d2ebf8b 1608@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1609@section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618the compiler.
1619
e2e0bcd1
JB
1620Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628@option{-g} alone.
1629
c906108c
SS
1630Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632executables containing debugging information.
1633
53a5351d
JM
1634@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1639
1640@cindex optimized code, debugging
1641@cindex debugging optimized code
1642When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1660@section Starting your program
1661@cindex starting
1662@cindex running
1663
1664@table @code
1665@kindex run
41afff9a 1666@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1667@item run
1668@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1669Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@end table
1676
c906108c
SS
1677If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687divided into four categories:
1688
1689@table @asis
1690@item The @emph{arguments.}
1691Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695the arguments.
1696In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700@item The @emph{environment.}
1701Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706@item The @emph{working directory.}
1707Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715set a different device for your program.
1716@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718@cindex pipes
1719@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722wrong program.
1723@end table
c906108c
SS
1724
1725When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734your current breakpoints.
1735
6d2ebf8b 1736@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1737@section Your program's arguments
1738
1739@cindex arguments (to your program)
1740The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1741@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1742They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1746the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1752
1753@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
c906108c 1756@table @code
41afff9a 1757@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1758@item set args
1759Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763it again without arguments.
1764
1765@kindex show args
1766@item show args
1767Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768@end table
1769
6d2ebf8b 1770@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1771@section Your program's environment
1772
1773@cindex environment (of your program)
1774The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782@table @code
1783@kindex path
1784@item path @var{directory}
1785Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1786(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1788You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1792
1793You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798@var{directory} to the search path.
1799@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802@kindex show paths
1803@item show paths
1804Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805environment variable).
1806
1807@kindex show environment
1808@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1815@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1816Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821null value.
1822@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825For example, this command:
1826
474c8240 1827@smallexample
c906108c 1828set env USER = foo
474c8240 1829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1830
1831@noindent
d4f3574e 1832tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1833@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834are not actually required.)
1835
1836@kindex unset environment
1837@item unset environment @var{varname}
1838Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842@end table
1843
d4f3574e
SS
1844@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1846by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852@file{.profile}.
1853
6d2ebf8b 1854@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1855@section Your program's working directory
1856
1857@cindex working directory (of your program)
1858Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866specify files}.
1867
1868@table @code
1869@kindex cd
1870@item cd @var{directory}
1871Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873@kindex pwd
1874@item pwd
1875Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876@end table
1877
6d2ebf8b 1878@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1879@section Your program's input and output
1880
1881@cindex redirection
1882@cindex i/o
1883@cindex terminal
1884By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1885the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1886to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888running your program.
1889
1890@table @code
1891@kindex info terminal
1892@item info terminal
1893Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894program is using.
1895@end table
1896
1897You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
474c8240 1900@smallexample
c906108c 1901run > outfile
474c8240 1902@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1903
1904@noindent
1905starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907@kindex tty
1908@cindex controlling terminal
1909Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
474c8240 1915@smallexample
c906108c 1916tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1917@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@noindent
1920directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926terminal.
1927
1928When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
6d2ebf8b 1932@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1933@section Debugging an already-running process
1934@kindex attach
1935@cindex attach
1936
1937@table @code
1938@item attach @var{process-id}
1939This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946executing the command.
1947@end table
1948
1949To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959Specify Files}.
1960
1961The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1963with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1967attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969@table @code
1970@kindex detach
1971@item detach
1972When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978executing the command.
1979@end table
1980
1981If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986messages}).
1987
6d2ebf8b 1988@node Kill Process
c906108c 1989@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@table @code
1992@kindex kill
1993@item kill
1994Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995@end table
1996
1997This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999is running.
2000
2001On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004outside the debugger.
2005
2006The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011breakpoint settings).
2012
6d2ebf8b 2013@node Threads
c906108c 2014@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex threads of execution
2017@cindex multiple threads
2018@cindex switching threads
2019In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028programs:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item automatic notification of new threads
2032@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2034@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2035a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036@item thread-specific breakpoints
2037@end itemize
2038
c906108c
SS
2039@quotation
2040@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045like this:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052@end smallexample
2053@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054@c doesn't support threads"?
2055@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@cindex focus of debugging
2058@cindex current thread
2059The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
41afff9a 2065@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2066@cindex thread identifier (system)
2067@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074LynxOS, you might see
2075
474c8240 2076@smallexample
c906108c 2077[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2079
2080@noindent
2081when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083further qualifier.
2084
2085@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2087@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2088@c program?
2089@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2091@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex thread number
2094@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098@table @code
2099@kindex info threads
2100@item info threads
2101Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104@enumerate
2105@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110@end enumerate
2111
2112@noindent
2113An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114indicates the current thread.
2115
5d161b24 2116For example,
c906108c
SS
2117@end table
2118@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120@smallexample
2121(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2127
2128On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@cindex thread number
2131@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134thread in your program.
2135
41afff9a
EZ
2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145HP-UX, you see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
5d161b24 2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2153
2154@table @code
2155@kindex info threads
2156@item info threads
2157Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160@enumerate
2161@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166@end enumerate
2167
2168@noindent
2169An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170indicates the current thread.
2171
5d161b24 2172For example,
c906108c
SS
2173@end table
2174@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
474c8240 2176@smallexample
c906108c 2177(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2185
2186@table @code
2187@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188@item thread @var{threadno}
2189Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195@smallexample
2196@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2198[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200@end smallexample
2201
2202@noindent
2203As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2205threads.
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@kindex thread apply
2208@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2213threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2215@end table
2216
2217@cindex automatic thread selection
2218@cindex switching threads automatically
2219@cindex threads, automatic switching
2220Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224thread.
2225
2226@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2234@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237@cindex multiple processes
2238@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2239On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2246
2247However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2255the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2256the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2257
53a5351d
JM
2258On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275@table @code
2276@item parent
2277The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2278unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2279
2280@item child
2281The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282unimpeded.
2283
2284@item ask
2285The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286@end table
2287
2288@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2289Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2290@end table
2291
2292If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304argument.
2305
2306You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2309
6d2ebf8b 2310@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2311@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
7a292a7a
SS
2317Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2324
2325@table @code
2326@kindex info program
2327@item info program
2328Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2329running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2330@end table
2331
2332@menu
2333* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2335* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2336* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2337@end menu
2338
6d2ebf8b 2339@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2340@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342@cindex breakpoints
2343A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349program.
2350
2351In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358@cindex watchpoints
2359@cindex memory tracing
2360@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371Automatic display}.
2372
2373@cindex catchpoints
2374@cindex breakpoint on events
2375A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2376when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2377exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2381@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2382
2383@cindex breakpoint numbers
2384@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391enable it again.
2392
c5394b80
JM
2393@cindex breakpoint ranges
2394@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
c906108c
SS
2401@menu
2402* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407* Conditions:: Break conditions
2408* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2409* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2410* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2411@end menu
2412
6d2ebf8b 2413@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2414@subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
5d161b24 2416@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2417@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418@c
2419@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2422@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2424@cindex latest breakpoint
2425Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2426@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2427number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2428Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429convenience variables.
2430
2431You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433@table @code
2434@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2435Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2436When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2437C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2438@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2439
2440@item break +@var{offset}
2441@itemx break -@var{offset}
2442Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2443at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2444(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@item break @var{linenum}
2447Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2448The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2450code on that line.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459functions.
2460
2461@item break *@var{address}
2462Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464information or source files.
2465
2466@item break
2467When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476inside loops.
2477
2478@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492@kindex tbreak
2493@item tbreak @var{args}
2494Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
c906108c
SS
2499@kindex hbreak
2500@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2501Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2503breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2505debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex thbreak
2517@item thbreak @var{args}
2518Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2520the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2521the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2523command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2525See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2526
2527@kindex rbreak
2528@cindex regular expression
2529@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2530Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2531@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2543
b37052ae 2544When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2545breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546classes.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex info breakpoints
2549@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556@table @emph
2557@item Breakpoint Numbers
2558@item Type
2559Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560@item Disposition
2561Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562@item Enabled or Disabled
2563Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564that are not enabled.
2565@item Address
2df3850c 2566Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2567@item What
2568Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569line number.
2570@end table
2571
2572@noindent
2573If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575are listed after that.
2576
2577@noindent
2578@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2582listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2583
2584@noindent
2585@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591@end table
2592
2593@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2600@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2604You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2605@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2606
2607
6d2ebf8b 2608@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2609@subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611@cindex setting watchpoints
2612@cindex software watchpoints
2613@cindex hardware watchpoints
2614You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616this may happen.
2617
2618Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2619hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2620program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623culprit.)
2624
d4f3574e 2625On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2626@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2627hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628program.
2629
2630@table @code
2631@kindex watch
2632@item watch @var{expr}
2633Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636@kindex rwatch
2637@item rwatch @var{expr}
2638Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2639
2640@kindex awatch
2641@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2642Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2643by the program.
c906108c
SS
2644
2645@kindex info watchpoints
2646@item info watchpoints
2647This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649@end table
2650
2651@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
474c8240 2660@smallexample
c906108c 2661Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
7be570e7
JM
2667Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673will print a message like this:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695@smallexample
2696Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697@end smallexample
2698
2699@noindent
2700If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2710@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2714any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2715kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
7be570e7
JM
2717@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
c906108c
SS
2727@quotation
2728@cindex watchpoints and threads
2729@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2730@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737the expression.
53a5351d 2738
d4f3574e 2739@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2740@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2749@end quotation
c906108c 2750
6d2ebf8b 2751@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2752@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2753@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2754@cindex exception handlers
2755@cindex event handling
2756
2757You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2758kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2759shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761@table @code
2762@kindex catch
2763@item catch @var{event}
2764Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765@table @code
2766@item throw
2767@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2768The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2769
2770@item catch
2771@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2772The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2773
2774@item exec
2775@kindex catch exec
2776A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778@item fork
2779@kindex catch fork
2780A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782@item vfork
2783@kindex catch vfork
2784A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786@item load
2787@itemx load @var{libname}
2788@kindex catch load
2789The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792@item unload
2793@itemx unload @var{libname}
2794@kindex catch unload
2795The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797@end table
2798
2799@item tcatch @var{event}
2800Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803@end table
2804
2805Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
b37052ae 2807There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2808(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810@itemize @bullet
2811@item
2812If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826@end itemize
2827
2828@cindex raise exceptions
2829Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2837knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2838raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
474c8240 2841@smallexample
c906108c 2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2846
2847@noindent
2848To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856raised.
2857
2858
6d2ebf8b 2859@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2860@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex clear
2880@item clear
2881Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886@item clear @var{function}
2887@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890@item clear @var{linenum}
2891@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894@cindex delete breakpoints
2895@kindex delete
41afff9a 2896@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2897@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2900breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902@end table
2903
6d2ebf8b 2904@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2905@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907@kindex disable breakpoints
2908@kindex enable breakpoints
2909Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921states of enablement:
2922
2923@itemize @bullet
2924@item
2925Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927@item
2928Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929@item
2930Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2931disabled.
c906108c
SS
2932@item
2933Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2934immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2936@end itemize
2937
2938You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex disable breakpoints
2943@kindex disable
41afff9a 2944@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2945@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2946Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952@kindex enable breakpoints
2953@kindex enable
c5394b80 2954@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2955Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
c5394b80 2958@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2959Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
c5394b80 2962@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2963Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965@end table
2966
d4f3574e
SS
2967@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2969Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975stepping}.)
2976
6d2ebf8b 2977@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2978@subsection Break conditions
2979@cindex conditional breakpoints
2980@cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2983@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2984The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001one.
3002
3003Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3010breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3012purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3019
c906108c
SS
3020You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex condition
3027@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3034referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036prints an error message:
3037
474c8240 3038@smallexample
d4f3574e 3039No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3040@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3041
3042@noindent
c906108c
SS
3043@value{GDBN} does
3044not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3045command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3047
3048@item condition @var{bnum}
3049Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051@end table
3052
3053@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063your program reaches it.
3064
3065@table @code
3066@kindex ignore
3067@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071takes no action.
3072
3073To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074a count of zero.
3075
3076When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088variables}.
3089@end table
3090
3091Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
6d2ebf8b 3094@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3095@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097@cindex breakpoint commands
3098You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103@table @code
3104@kindex commands
3105@kindex end
3106@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108@itemx end
3109Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118recently encountered).
3119@end table
3120
3121Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126that resumes execution.
3127
3128Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134@kindex silent
3135If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
474c8240 3149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3150break foo if x>0
3151commands
3152silent
3153printf "x is %d\n",x
3154cont
3155end
474c8240 3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
474c8240 3166@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3167break 403
3168commands
3169silent
3170set x = y + 4
3171cont
3172end
474c8240 3173@end smallexample
c906108c 3174
6d2ebf8b 3175@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3176@subsection Breakpoint menus
3177@cindex overloading
3178@cindex symbol overloading
3179
b37052ae 3180Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3181to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192breakpoints.
3193
3194For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199@smallexample
3200@group
3201(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202[0] cancel
3203[1] all
3204[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210> 2 4 6
3211Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217(@value{GDBP})
3218@end group
3219@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3222@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3223@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3224@c
3225@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226@c
d4f3574e
SS
3227Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3229attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3230@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
474c8240 3232@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3235@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236
3237When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239@enumerate
3240@item
3241Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243@item
5d161b24 3244Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3245name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3246that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3247Then start your program again.
3248
3249@item
3250Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252to nonsharable executables.
3253@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3254@c @end ifclear
3255
d4f3574e
SS
3256A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261@smallexample
3262Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264@end smallexample
3265
3266@noindent
3267This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
6d2ebf8b 3275@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3276@section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278@cindex stepping
3279@cindex continuing
3280@cindex resuming execution
3281@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3285particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3287it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3289
3290@table @code
3291@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3292@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3294@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305@code{continue} is ignored.
3306
d4f3574e
SS
3307The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3311@end table
3312
3313To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325@table @code
3326@kindex step
41afff9a 3327@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3328@item step
3329Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333@quotation
3334@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337@c distinction here.
3338@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344below.
3345@end quotation
3346
4a92d011
EZ
3347The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352called within the line.
c906108c 3353
d4f3574e
SS
3354Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3356@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3357on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3358was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3359
3360@item step @var{count}
3361Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3362breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3364
3365@kindex next
41afff9a 3366@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3367@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3369This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3374
3375An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380@c
3381@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383@c function are executed without stopping.
3384
d4f3574e
SS
3385The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3387@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3388
b90a5f51
CF
3389@kindex set step-mode
3390@item set step-mode
3391@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3394The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3395stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396information rather than stepping over it.
3397
4a92d011
EZ
3398This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3401
3402@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3403Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3404debug information. This is the default.
3405
c906108c
SS
3406@kindex finish
3407@item finish
3408Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414@kindex until
41afff9a 3415@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3416@item until
3417@itemx u
3418Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423than the address of the jump.
3424
3425This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429through the next iteration.
3430
3431@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432stack frame.
3433
3434@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
474c8240 3440@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3441(@value{GDBP}) f
3442#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443206 expand_input();
3444(@value{GDBP}) until
3445195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3446@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3447
3448This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458argument.
3459
3460@item until @var{location}
3461@itemx u @var{location}
3462Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3465,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3466and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3467
3468@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3469@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3470@item stepi
96a2c332 3471@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3472@itemx si
3473Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3474
3475It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3476instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3477instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3478Display,, Automatic display}.
3479
3480An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3481
3482@need 750
3483@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3484@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3485@item nexti
96a2c332 3486@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3487@itemx ni
3488Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3489proceed until the function returns.
3490
3491An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3492@end table
3493
6d2ebf8b 3494@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3495@section Signals
3496@cindex signals
3497
3498A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3499operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3500kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3501signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3502@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3503memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3504the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3505requested an alarm).
3506
3507@cindex fatal signals
3508Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3509functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3510errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3511program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3512@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3513fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3514
3515@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3516program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3517signal.
3518
3519@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3520Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3521@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3522(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3523but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3524You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3525
3526@table @code
3527@kindex info signals
3528@item info signals
96a2c332 3529@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3530Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3531handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3532the defined types of signals.
3533
d4f3574e 3534@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3535
3536@kindex handle
3537@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3538Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3539can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3540@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3541@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3542known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3543@end table
3544
3545@c @group
3546The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3547Their full names are:
3548
3549@table @code
3550@item nostop
3551@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3552still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3553
3554@item stop
3555@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3556the @code{print} keyword as well.
3557
3558@item print
3559@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3560
3561@item noprint
3562@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3563implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3564
3565@item pass
5ece1a18 3566@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3567@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3568can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3569and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3570
3571@item nopass
5ece1a18 3572@itemx ignore
c906108c 3573@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3574@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3575@end table
3576@c @end group
3577
d4f3574e
SS
3578When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3579program until you
c906108c
SS
3580continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3581effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3582after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3583command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3584program sees that signal when you continue.
3585
24f93129
EZ
3586The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3587non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3588@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3589erroneous signals.
3590
c906108c
SS
3591You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3592seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3593or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3594due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3595values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3596execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3597a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3598you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3599program a signal}.
c906108c 3600
6d2ebf8b 3601@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3602@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3603
3604When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3605programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3606breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3607
3608@table @code
3609@cindex breakpoints and threads
3610@cindex thread breakpoints
3611@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3612@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3613@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3614@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3615writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3616
3617Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3618to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3619particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3620numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3621column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3622
3623If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3624breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3625program.
3626
3627You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3628well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3629breakpoint condition, like this:
3630
3631@smallexample
2df3850c 3632(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3633@end smallexample
3634
3635@end table
3636
3637@cindex stopped threads
3638@cindex threads, stopped
3639Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3640@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3641allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3642switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3643underfoot.
3644
3645@cindex continuing threads
3646@cindex threads, continuing
3647Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3648executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3649like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3650
3651In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3652Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3653system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3654execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3655single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3656statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3657stops.
3658
3659You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3660continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3661thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3662first thread completes whatever you requested.
3663
3664On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3665thread to run.
3666
3667@table @code
3668@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3669Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3670locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3671current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3672mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3673``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3674stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3675when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3676function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3677like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3678thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3679@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3680
3681@item show scheduler-locking
3682Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3683@end table
3684
c906108c 3685
6d2ebf8b 3686@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3687@chapter Examining the Stack
3688
3689When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3690stopped and how it got there.
3691
3692@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3693Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3694is generated.
3695That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3696the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3697and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3698The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3699The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3700stack}.
3701
3702When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3703stack allow you to see all of this information.
3704
3705@cindex selected frame
3706One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3707@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3708particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3709your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3710special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3711interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3712
3713When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3714currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3715@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3716
3717@menu
3718* Frames:: Stack frames
3719* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3720* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3721* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3722
3723@end menu
3724
6d2ebf8b 3725@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3726@section Stack frames
3727
d4f3574e 3728@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3729@cindex stack frame
3730The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3731frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3732with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3733to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3734which the function is executing.
3735
3736@cindex initial frame
3737@cindex outermost frame
3738@cindex innermost frame
3739When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3740function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3741@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3742made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3743is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3744the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3745actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3746recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3747
3748@cindex frame pointer
3749Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3750stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3751kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3752address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3753in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3754going on in that frame.
3755
3756@cindex frame number
3757@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3758zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3759and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3760they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3761frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3762
6d2ebf8b
SS
3763@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3764@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3765@cindex frameless execution
3766Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3767without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3768@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3769@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3770@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3771generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3772This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3773the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3774with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3775has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3776it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3777correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3778no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3779
3780@table @code
d4f3574e 3781@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3782@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3783@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3784The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3785and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3786address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3787@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3788
3789@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3790@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3791@item select-frame
3792The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3793to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3794@code{frame}.
3795@end table
3796
6d2ebf8b 3797@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3798@section Backtraces
3799
3800@cindex backtraces
3801@cindex tracebacks
3802@cindex stack traces
3803A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3804line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3805frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3806stack.
3807
3808@table @code
3809@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3810@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3811@item backtrace
3812@itemx bt
3813Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3814frames in the stack.
3815
3816You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3817character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3818
3819@item backtrace @var{n}
3820@itemx bt @var{n}
3821Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3822
3823@item backtrace -@var{n}
3824@itemx bt -@var{n}
3825Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3826@end table
3827
3828@kindex where
3829@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3830@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3831The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3832are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3833
3834Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3835The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3836print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3837line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3838counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3839line number.
3840
3841Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3842@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3843
3844@smallexample
3845@group
5d161b24 3846#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3847 at builtin.c:993
3848#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3849#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3850 at macro.c:71
3851(More stack frames follow...)
3852@end group
3853@end smallexample
3854
3855@noindent
3856The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3857value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3858code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3859
6d2ebf8b 3860@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3861@section Selecting a frame
3862
3863Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3864whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3865selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3866of the stack frame just selected.
3867
3868@table @code
d4f3574e 3869@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3870@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3871@item frame @var{n}
3872@itemx f @var{n}
3873Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3874(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3875innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3876@code{main}.
3877
3878@item frame @var{addr}
3879@itemx f @var{addr}
3880Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3881chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3882impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3883addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3884switches between them.
3885
c906108c
SS
3886On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3887select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3888
3889On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3890pointer and a program counter.
3891
3892On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3893pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3894@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3895@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3896@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3897
3898@kindex up
3899@item up @var{n}
3900Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3901advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3902that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3903
3904@kindex down
41afff9a 3905@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3906@item down @var{n}
3907Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3908advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3909that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3910abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3911@end table
3912
3913All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3914frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3915arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3916frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3917
3918@need 1000
3919For example:
3920
3921@smallexample
3922@group
3923(@value{GDBP}) up
3924#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3925 at env.c:10
392610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3927@end group
3928@end smallexample
3929
3930After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3931prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3932You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3933editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3934@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3935for details.
c906108c
SS
3936
3937@table @code
3938@kindex down-silently
3939@kindex up-silently
3940@item up-silently @var{n}
3941@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3942These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3943respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3944causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3945in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3946distracting.
3947@end table
3948
6d2ebf8b 3949@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3950@section Information about a frame
3951
3952There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3953stack frame.
3954
3955@table @code
3956@item frame
3957@itemx f
3958When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3959frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3960selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3961argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3962@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3963
3964@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3965@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3966@item info frame
3967@itemx info f
3968This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3969including:
3970
3971@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3972@item
3973the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3974@item
3975the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3976@item
3977the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3978@item
3979the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3980@item
3981the address of the frame's arguments
3982@item
d4f3574e
SS
3983the address of the frame's local variables
3984@item
c906108c
SS
3985the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3986@item
3987which registers were saved in the frame
3988@end itemize
3989
3990@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3991something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3992the usual conventions.
3993
3994@item info frame @var{addr}
3995@itemx info f @var{addr}
3996Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3997selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3998command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3999architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4000@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4001
4002@kindex info args
4003@item info args
4004Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4005
4006@item info locals
4007@kindex info locals
4008Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4009line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4010accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4011
c906108c 4012@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4013@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4014@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4015@item info catch
4016Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4017current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4018exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4019@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4020@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4021
c906108c
SS
4022@end table
4023
c906108c 4024
6d2ebf8b 4025@node Source
c906108c
SS
4026@chapter Examining Source Files
4027
4028@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4029information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4030used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4031the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4032(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4033execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4034source files by explicit command.
4035
7a292a7a 4036If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4037prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4038@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4039
4040@menu
4041* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4042* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4043* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4044* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4045* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4046@end menu
4047
6d2ebf8b 4048@node List
c906108c
SS
4049@section Printing source lines
4050
4051@kindex list
41afff9a 4052@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4053To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4054(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4055There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4056
4057Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4058
4059@table @code
4060@item list @var{linenum}
4061Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4062current source file.
4063
4064@item list @var{function}
4065Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4066@var{function}.
4067
4068@item list
4069Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4070@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4071printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4072as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4073Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4074
4075@item list -
4076Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4077@end table
4078
4079By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4080the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4081
4082@table @code
4083@kindex set listsize
4084@item set listsize @var{count}
4085Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4086the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4087
4088@kindex show listsize
4089@item show listsize
4090Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4091@end table
4092
4093Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4094so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4095than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4096argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4097each repetition moves up in the source file.
4098
4099@cindex linespec
4100In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4101@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4102of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4103Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4104
4105@table @code
4106@item list @var{linespec}
4107Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4108
4109@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4110Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4111linespecs.
4112
4113@item list ,@var{last}
4114Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4115
4116@item list @var{first},
4117Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4118
4119@item list +
4120Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4121
4122@item list -
4123Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4124
4125@item list
4126As described in the preceding table.
4127@end table
4128
4129Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4130kinds of linespec.
4131
4132@table @code
4133@item @var{number}
4134Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4135When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4136the same source file as the first linespec.
4137
4138@item +@var{offset}
4139Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4140When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4141two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4142first linespec.
4143
4144@item -@var{offset}
4145Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4146
4147@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4148Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4149
4150@item @var{function}
4151Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4152For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4153
4154@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4155Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4156function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4157file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4158identically named functions in different source files.
4159
4160@item *@var{address}
4161Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4162@var{address} may be any expression.
4163@end table
4164
87885426
FN
4165@node Edit
4166@section Editing source files
4167@cindex editing source files
4168
4169@kindex edit
4170@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4171To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4172The editing program of your choice
4173is invoked with the current line set to
4174the active line in the program.
4175Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4176want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4177
4178Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4179
4180@table @code
4181@item edit
4182Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4183
4184@item edit @var{number}
4185Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4186
4187@item edit @var{function}
4188Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4189
4190@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4191Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4192
4193@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4194Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4195function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4196file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4197identically named functions in different source files.
4198
4199@item edit *@var{address}
4200Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4201@var{address} may be any expression.
4202@end table
4203
4204@subsection Choosing your editor
4205You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4206@footnote{
4207The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4208following command-line syntax:
4209@example
4210ex +@var{number} file
4211@end example
4212The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in the file.
4213}.
4214By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this by setting the
4215environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4216@value{GDBN}.
4217For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the @code{vi} editor, you
4218could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4219@example
4220EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4221export EDITOR
4222gdb ...
4223@end example
4224or in the @code{csh} shell,
4225@example
4226setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4227gdb ...
4228@end example
4229
6d2ebf8b 4230@node Search
c906108c
SS
4231@section Searching source files
4232@cindex searching
4233@kindex reverse-search
4234
4235There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4236regular expression.
4237
4238@table @code
4239@kindex search
4240@kindex forward-search
4241@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4242@itemx search @var{regexp}
4243The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4244starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4245@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4246synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4247@code{fo}.
4248
4249@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4250The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4251with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4252for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4253this command as @code{rev}.
4254@end table
c906108c 4255
6d2ebf8b 4256@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4257@section Specifying source directories
4258
4259@cindex source path
4260@cindex directories for source files
4261Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4262files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4263the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4264session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4265this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4266it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4267in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4268the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4269the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4270path.
4271
4272If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4273object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4274too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4275compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4276last resort.
4277
4278Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4279any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4280each line is in the file.
4281
4282@kindex directory
4283@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4284When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4285and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4286To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4287
4288@table @code
4289@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4290@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4291Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4292directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4293(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4294part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4295whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4296path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4297
4298@kindex cdir
4299@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4300@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4301@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4302@cindex compilation directory
4303@cindex current directory
4304@cindex working directory
4305@cindex directory, current
4306@cindex directory, compilation
4307You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4308directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4309working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4310tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4311session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4312directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4313
4314@item directory
4315Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4316
4317@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4318@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4319
4320@item show directories
4321@kindex show directories
4322Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4323@end table
4324
4325If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4326interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4327versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4328
4329@enumerate
4330@item
4331Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4332
4333@item
4334Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4335directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4336directories in one command.
4337@end enumerate
4338
6d2ebf8b 4339@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4340@section Source and machine code
4341
4342You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4343addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4344a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4345mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4346line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4347well as hex.
4348
4349@table @code
4350@kindex info line
4351@item info line @var{linespec}
4352Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4353source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4354the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4355source lines}).
4356@end table
4357
4358For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4359the object code for the first line of function
4360@code{m4_changequote}:
4361
d4f3574e
SS
4362@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4363@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4364@smallexample
96a2c332 4365(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4366Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4367@end smallexample
4368
4369@noindent
4370We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4371@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4372@smallexample
4373(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4374Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4375@end smallexample
4376
4377@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4378@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4379After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4380is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4381sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4382,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4383convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4384variables}).
4385
4386@table @code
4387@kindex disassemble
4388@cindex assembly instructions
4389@cindex instructions, assembly
4390@cindex machine instructions
4391@cindex listing machine instructions
4392@item disassemble
4393This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4394instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4395program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4396command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4397surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4398(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4399@end table
4400
c906108c
SS
4401The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4402HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4403
4404@smallexample
4405(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4406Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44070x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44080x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44090x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44100x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44110x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44120x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44130x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44140x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4415End of assembler dump.
4416@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4417
4418Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4419mnemonics or other syntax.
4420
4421@table @code
d4f3574e 4422@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4423@cindex assembly instructions
4424@cindex instructions, assembly
4425@cindex machine instructions
4426@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4427@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4428@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4429@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4430Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4431program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4432
4433Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4434can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4435The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4436assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4437@end table
4438
4439
6d2ebf8b 4440@node Data
c906108c
SS
4441@chapter Examining Data
4442
4443@cindex printing data
4444@cindex examining data
4445@kindex print
4446@kindex inspect
4447@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4448@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4449@c different window or something like that.
4450The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4451command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4452evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4453program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4454Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4455
4456@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4457@item print @var{expr}
4458@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4459@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4460value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4461you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4462@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4463formats}.
4464
4465@item print
4466@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4467If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4468@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4469conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4470@end table
4471
4472A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4473It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4474specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4475
7a292a7a 4476If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4477fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4478command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4479Table}.
c906108c
SS
4480
4481@menu
4482* Expressions:: Expressions
4483* Variables:: Program variables
4484* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4485* Output Formats:: Output formats
4486* Memory:: Examining memory
4487* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4488* Print Settings:: Print settings
4489* Value History:: Value history
4490* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4491* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4492* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4493* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4494* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4495* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
c906108c
SS
4496@end menu
4497
6d2ebf8b 4498@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4499@section Expressions
4500
4501@cindex expressions
4502@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4503compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4504by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4505@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4506casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4507you compiled your program to include this information; see
4508@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4509
d4f3574e
SS
4510@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4511the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4512you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4513memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4514
c906108c
SS
4515Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4516this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4517Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4518languages.
4519
4520In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4521expressions regardless of your programming language.
4522
4523Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4524useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4525at that address in memory.
4526@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4527
4528@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4529to programming languages:
4530
4531@table @code
4532@item @@
4533@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4534@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4535
4536@item ::
4537@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4538function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4539
4540@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4541@cindex type casting memory
4542@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4543@cindex casts, to view memory
4544@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4545Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4546memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4547pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4548a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4549normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4550@end table
4551
6d2ebf8b 4552@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4553@section Program variables
4554
4555The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4556in your program.
4557
4558Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4559(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4560
4561@itemize @bullet
4562@item
4563global (or file-static)
4564@end itemize
4565
5d161b24 4566@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4567
4568@itemize @bullet
4569@item
4570visible according to the scope rules of the
4571programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4572@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4573
4574@noindent This means that in the function
4575
474c8240 4576@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4577foo (a)
4578 int a;
4579@{
4580 bar (a);
4581 @{
4582 int b = test ();
4583 bar (b);
4584 @}
4585@}
474c8240 4586@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4587
4588@noindent
4589you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4590executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4591examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4592the block where @code{b} is declared.
4593
4594@cindex variable name conflict
4595There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4596scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4597in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4598function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4599happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4600you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4601using the colon-colon notation:
4602
d4f3574e 4603@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4604@iftex
4605@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4606@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4607@end iftex
474c8240 4608@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4609@var{file}::@var{variable}
4610@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4611@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4612
4613@noindent
4614Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4615static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4616make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4617to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4618
474c8240 4619@smallexample
c906108c 4620(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4621@end smallexample
c906108c 4622
b37052ae 4623@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4624This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4625use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4626scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4627@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4628@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4629
4630@cindex wrong values
4631@cindex variable values, wrong
4632@quotation
4633@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4634wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4635scope, and just before exit.
4636@end quotation
4637You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4638This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4639set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4640stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4641values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4642also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4643after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4644variable definitions may be gone.
4645
4646This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4647To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4648when compiling.
4649
d4f3574e
SS
4650@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4651Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4652unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4653opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4654offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4655might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4656happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4657
474c8240 4658@smallexample
d4f3574e 4659No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4660@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4661
4662To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4663different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4664formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4665supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4666in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4667to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4668debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4669Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4670information.
4671
4672
6d2ebf8b 4673@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4674@section Artificial arrays
4675
4676@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4677@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4678It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4679same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4680dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4681program.
4682
4683You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4684@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4685operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4686and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4687of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4688the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4689argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4690following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4691example. If a program says
4692
474c8240 4693@smallexample
c906108c 4694int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4695@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4696
4697@noindent
4698you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4699
474c8240 4700@smallexample
c906108c 4701p *array@@len
474c8240 4702@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4703
4704The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4705with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4706subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4707Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4708(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4709
4710Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4711This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4712The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4713@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4714(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4715$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4716@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4717
4718As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4719@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4720the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4721@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4722(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4723$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4724@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4725
4726Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4727moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4728actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4729of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4730to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4731variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4732interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4733instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4734structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4735in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4736
474c8240 4737@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4738set $i = 0
4739p dtab[$i++]->fv
4740@key{RET}
4741@key{RET}
4742@dots{}
474c8240 4743@end smallexample
c906108c 4744
6d2ebf8b 4745@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4746@section Output formats
4747
4748@cindex formatted output
4749@cindex output formats
4750By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4751this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4752in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4753at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4754these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4755
4756The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4757already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4758@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4759letters supported are:
4760
4761@table @code
4762@item x
4763Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4764hexadecimal.
4765
4766@item d
4767Print as integer in signed decimal.
4768
4769@item u
4770Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4771
4772@item o
4773Print as integer in octal.
4774
4775@item t
4776Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4777@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4778used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4779see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4780
4781@item a
4782@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4783@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4784Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4785the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4786where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4787
474c8240 4788@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4789(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4790$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4791@end smallexample
c906108c 4792
3d67e040
EZ
4793@noindent
4794The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4795@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4796
c906108c
SS
4797@item c
4798Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4799
4800@item f
4801Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4802using typical floating point syntax.
4803@end table
4804
4805For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4806
474c8240 4807@smallexample
c906108c 4808p/x $pc
474c8240 4809@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4810
4811@noindent
4812Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4813names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4814
4815To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4816you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4817expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4818
6d2ebf8b 4819@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4820@section Examining memory
4821
4822You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4823any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4824
4825@cindex examining memory
4826@table @code
41afff9a 4827@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4828@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4829@itemx x @var{addr}
4830@itemx x
4831Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4832@end table
4833
4834@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4835much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4836expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4837If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4838Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4839
4840@table @r
4841@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4842The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4843how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4844@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4845@c 4.1.2.
4846
4847@item @var{f}, the display format
4848The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4849@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4850The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4851The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4852
4853@item @var{u}, the unit size
4854The unit size is any of
4855
4856@table @code
4857@item b
4858Bytes.
4859@item h
4860Halfwords (two bytes).
4861@item w
4862Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4863@item g
4864Giant words (eight bytes).
4865@end table
4866
4867Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4868default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4869@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4870
4871@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4872@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4873memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4874it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4875@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4876@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4877other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4878the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4879starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4880a value from memory).
4881@end table
4882
4883For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4884(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4885starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4886words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4887@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4888
4889Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4890letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4891unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4892specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4893(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4894
4895Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4896and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4897@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4898including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4899alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4900Code,,Source and machine code}.
4901
4902All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4903easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4904you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4905instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4906with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4907the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4908for successive uses of @code{x}.
4909
4910@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4911The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4912in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4913would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4914subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4915@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4916examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4917@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4918the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4919
4920If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4921are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4922address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4923
6d2ebf8b 4924@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4925@section Automatic display
4926@cindex automatic display
4927@cindex display of expressions
4928
4929If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4930(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4931display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4932Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4933to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4934The automatic display looks like this:
4935
474c8240 4936@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49372: foo = 38
49383: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4939@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4940
4941@noindent
4942This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4943displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4944specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4945whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4946format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4947or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4948supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4949
4950@table @code
4951@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4952@item display @var{expr}
4953Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4954each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4955
4956@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4957
d4f3574e 4958@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4959For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4960count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4961arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4962@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4963
4964@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4965For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4966number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4967be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4968doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4969@end table
4970
4971For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4972instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4973is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4974
4975@table @code
4976@kindex delete display
4977@kindex undisplay
4978@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4979@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4980Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4981
4982@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4983(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4984
4985@kindex disable display
4986@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4987Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4988item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4989enabled again later.
4990
4991@kindex enable display
4992@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4993Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4994again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4995
4996@item display
4997Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4998done when your program stops.
4999
5000@kindex info display
5001@item info display
5002Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5003automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5004values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5005It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5006because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5007@end table
5008
5009If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5010sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5011expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5012variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5013@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5014@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5015continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5016there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5017automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5018is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5019
6d2ebf8b 5020@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5021@section Print settings
5022
5023@cindex format options
5024@cindex print settings
5025@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5026and symbols are printed.
5027
5028@noindent
5029These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5030
5031@table @code
5032@kindex set print address
5033@item set print address
5034@itemx set print address on
5035@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5036traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5037even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5038is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5039@code{set print address on}:
5040
5041@smallexample
5042@group
5043(@value{GDBP}) f
5044#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5045 at input.c:530
5046530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5047@end group
5048@end smallexample
5049
5050@item set print address off
5051Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5052this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5053
5054@smallexample
5055@group
5056(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5057(@value{GDBP}) f
5058#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5059530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5060@end group
5061@end smallexample
5062
5063You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5064dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5065@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5066all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5067
5068@kindex show print address
5069@item show print address
5070Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5071@end table
5072
5073When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5074closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5075identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5076source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5077@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5078you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5079it prints a symbolic address:
5080
5081@table @code
5082@kindex set print symbol-filename
5083@item set print symbol-filename on
5084Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5085symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5086
5087@item set print symbol-filename off
5088Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5089default.
5090
5091@kindex show print symbol-filename
5092@item show print symbol-filename
5093Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5094line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5095@end table
5096
5097Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5098numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5099number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5100
5101Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5102printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5103
5104@table @code
5105@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5106@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5107Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5108offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5109@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5110to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5111
5112@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5113@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5114Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5115symbolic address.
5116@end table
5117
5118@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5119@cindex pointer, finding referent
5120If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5121@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5122and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5123@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5124For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5125at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5126
474c8240 5127@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5128(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5129(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5130$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5131@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5132
5133@quotation
5134@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5135does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5136the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5137@end quotation
5138
5139Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5140
5141@table @code
5142@kindex set print array
5143@item set print array
5144@itemx set print array on
5145Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5146but uses more space. The default is off.
5147
5148@item set print array off
5149Return to compressed format for arrays.
5150
5151@kindex show print array
5152@item show print array
5153Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5154arrays.
5155
5156@kindex set print elements
5157@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5158Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5159If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5160printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5161This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5162When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5163Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5164
5165@kindex show print elements
5166@item show print elements
5167Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5168If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5169
5170@kindex set print null-stop
5171@item set print null-stop
5172Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5173@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5174contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5175The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5176
5177@kindex set print pretty
5178@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5179Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5180per line, like this:
5181
5182@smallexample
5183@group
5184$1 = @{
5185 next = 0x0,
5186 flags = @{
5187 sweet = 1,
5188 sour = 1
5189 @},
5190 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5191@}
5192@end group
5193@end smallexample
5194
5195@item set print pretty off
5196Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5197
5198@smallexample
5199@group
5200$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5201meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5202@end group
5203@end smallexample
5204
5205@noindent
5206This is the default format.
5207
5208@kindex show print pretty
5209@item show print pretty
5210Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5211
5212@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5213@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5214Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5215@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5216character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5217best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5218high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5219
5220@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5221Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5222international character sets, and is the default.
5223
5224@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5225@item show print sevenbit-strings
5226Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5227
5228@kindex set print union
5229@item set print union on
5d161b24 5230Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5231is the default setting.
5232
5233@item set print union off
5234Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5235
5236@kindex show print union
5237@item show print union
5238Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5239structures.
5240
5241For example, given the declarations
5242
5243@smallexample
5244typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5245typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5246typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5247 Bug_forms;
5248
5249struct thing @{
5250 Species it;
5251 union @{
5252 Tree_forms tree;
5253 Bug_forms bug;
5254 @} form;
5255@};
5256
5257struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5258@end smallexample
5259
5260@noindent
5261with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5262
5263@smallexample
5264$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5265@end smallexample
5266
5267@noindent
5268and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5269
5270@smallexample
5271$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5272@end smallexample
5273@end table
5274
c906108c
SS
5275@need 1000
5276@noindent
b37052ae 5277These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5278
5279@table @code
5280@cindex demangling
5281@kindex set print demangle
5282@item set print demangle
5283@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5284Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5285(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5286linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5287
5288@kindex show print demangle
5289@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5290Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5291
5292@kindex set print asm-demangle
5293@item set print asm-demangle
5294@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5295Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5296in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5297The default is off.
5298
5299@kindex show print asm-demangle
5300@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5301Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5302or demangled form.
5303
5304@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5305@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5306@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5307@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5308Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5309represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5310
5311@table @code
5312@item auto
5313Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5314
5315@item gnu
b37052ae 5316Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5317This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5318
5319@item hp
b37052ae 5320Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5321
5322@item lucid
b37052ae 5323Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5324
5325@item arm
b37052ae 5326Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5327@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5328debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5329require further enhancement to permit that.
5330
5331@end table
5332If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5333
5334@kindex show demangle-style
5335@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5336Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5337
5338@kindex set print object
5339@item set print object
5340@itemx set print object on
5341When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5342(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5343the virtual function table.
5344
5345@item set print object off
5346Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5347virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5348
5349@kindex show print object
5350@item show print object
5351Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5352
5353@kindex set print static-members
5354@item set print static-members
5355@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5356Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5357
5358@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5359Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5360
5361@kindex show print static-members
5362@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5363Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5364
5365@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5366@kindex set print vtbl
5367@item set print vtbl
5368@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5369Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5370(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5371ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5372
5373@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5374Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5375
5376@kindex show print vtbl
5377@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5378Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5379@end table
c906108c 5380
6d2ebf8b 5381@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5382@section Value history
5383
5384@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5385Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5386@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5387Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5388(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5389When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5390since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5391symbol table.
5392
5393@cindex @code{$}
5394@cindex @code{$$}
5395@cindex history number
5396The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5397refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5398@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5399printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5400history number.
5401
5402To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5403history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5404remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5405the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5406@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5407is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5408@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5409
5410For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5411want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5412
474c8240 5413@smallexample
c906108c 5414p *$
474c8240 5415@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5416
5417If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5418to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5419
474c8240 5420@smallexample
c906108c 5421p *$.next
474c8240 5422@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5423
5424@noindent
5425You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5426command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5427
5428Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5429@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5430
474c8240 5431@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5432print x
5433set x=5
474c8240 5434@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5435
5436@noindent
5437then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5438remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5439
5440@table @code
5441@kindex show values
5442@item show values
5443Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5444This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5445values} does not change the history.
5446
5447@item show values @var{n}
5448Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5449
5450@item show values +
5451Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5452values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5453@end table
5454
5455Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5456same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5457
6d2ebf8b 5458@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5459@section Convenience variables
5460
5461@cindex convenience variables
5462@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5463@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5464exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5465setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5466of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5467
5468Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5469@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5470the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5471(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5472by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5473
5474You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5475expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5476For example:
5477
474c8240 5478@smallexample
c906108c 5479set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5480@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5481
5482@noindent
5483would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5484@code{object_ptr}.
5485
5486Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5487value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5488value with another assignment at any time.
5489
5490Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5491variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5492that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5493variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5494
5495@table @code
5496@kindex show convenience
5497@item show convenience
5498Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5499Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5500@end table
5501
5502One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5503incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5504a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5505
474c8240 5506@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5507set $i = 0
5508print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5509@end smallexample
c906108c 5510
d4f3574e
SS
5511@noindent
5512Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5513
5514Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5515values likely to be useful.
5516
5517@table @code
41afff9a 5518@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5519@item $_
5520The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5521the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5522commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5523set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5524and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5525except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5526to the type of @code{$__}.
5527
41afff9a 5528@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5529@item $__
5530The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5531to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5532to match the format in which the data was printed.
5533
5534@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5535@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5536The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5537the program being debugged terminates.
5538@end table
5539
53a5351d
JM
5540On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5541begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5542name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5543
6d2ebf8b 5544@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5545@section Registers
5546
5547@cindex registers
5548You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5549with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5550for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5551your machine.
5552
5553@table @code
5554@kindex info registers
5555@item info registers
5556Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5557registers (in the selected stack frame).
5558
5559@kindex info all-registers
5560@cindex floating point registers
5561@item info all-registers
5562Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5563registers.
5564
5565@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5566Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5567As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5568the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5569the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5570@end table
5571
5572@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5573expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5574architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5575@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5576the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5577pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5578register that contains the processor status. For example,
5579you could print the program counter in hex with
5580
474c8240 5581@smallexample
c906108c 5582p/x $pc
474c8240 5583@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5584
5585@noindent
5586or print the instruction to be executed next with
5587
474c8240 5588@smallexample
c906108c 5589x/i $pc
474c8240 5590@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5591
5592@noindent
5593or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5594one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5595memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5596stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5597stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5598regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5599see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5600
474c8240 5601@smallexample
c906108c 5602set $sp += 4
474c8240 5603@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5604
5605Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5606your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5607so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5608shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5609registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5610can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5611is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5612
5613@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5614integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5615special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5616registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5617to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5618(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5619@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5620
5621Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5622means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5623the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5624sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5625coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5626programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5627cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5628that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5629prints the data in both formats.
5630
5631Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5632(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5633value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5634were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5635true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5636frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5637
5638However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5639code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5640@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5641frame makes no difference.
5642
6d2ebf8b 5643@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5644@section Floating point hardware
5645@cindex floating point
5646
5647Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5648you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5649
5650@table @code
5651@kindex info float
5652@item info float
5653Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5654point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5655floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5656the ARM and x86 machines.
5657@end table
c906108c 5658
e76f1f2e
AC
5659@node Vector Unit
5660@section Vector Unit
5661@cindex vector unit
5662
5663Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5664more information about the status of the vector unit.
5665
5666@table @code
5667@kindex info vector
5668@item info vector
5669Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5670layout vary depending on the hardware.
5671@end table
5672
29e57380 5673@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5674@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5675@cindex memory region attributes
5676
5677@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5678required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5679to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5680use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5681
5682Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5683memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5684accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5685been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5686all memory.
5687
5688When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5689to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5690
5691@table @code
5692@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5693@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5694Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5695attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5696special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5697(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5698
5699@kindex delete mem
5700@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5701Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5702
5703@kindex disable mem
5704@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5705Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5706A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5707It may be enabled again later.
5708
5709@kindex enable mem
5710@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5711Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5712
5713@kindex info mem
5714@item info mem
5715Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5716for each region.
5717
5718@table @emph
5719@item Memory Region Number
5720@item Enabled or Disabled.
5721Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5722Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5723
5724@item Lo Address
5725The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5726
5727@item Hi Address
5728The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5729
5730@item Attributes
5731The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5732@end table
5733@end table
5734
5735
5736@subsection Attributes
5737
5738@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5739The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5740write accesses to a memory region.
5741
5742While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5743memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5744etc. from accessing memory.
5745
5746@table @code
5747@item ro
5748Memory is read only.
5749@item wo
5750Memory is write only.
5751@item rw
6ca652b0 5752Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5753@end table
5754
5755@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5756The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5757accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5758require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5759specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5760
5761@table @code
5762@item 8
5763Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5764@item 16
5765Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5766@item 32
5767Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5768@item 64
5769Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5770@end table
5771
5772@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5773@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5774@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5775@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5776@c
5777@c @table @code
5778@c @item hwbreak
5779@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5780@c @item swbreak (default)
5781@c @end table
5782
5783@subsubsection Data Cache
5784The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5785memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5786protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5787does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5788registers.
5789
5790@table @code
5791@item cache
5792Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5793@item nocache
5794Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5795@end table
5796
5797@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5798@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5799@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5800@c
5801@c @table @code
5802@c @item verify
5803@c @item noverify (default)
5804@c @end table
5805
16d9dec6
MS
5806@node Dump/Restore Files
5807@section Copy between memory and a file
5808@cindex dump/restore files
5809@cindex append data to a file
5810@cindex dump data to a file
5811@cindex restore data from a file
5812@kindex dump
5813@kindex append
5814@kindex restore
5815
5816The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5817for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5818into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5819file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5820intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5821
5822@table @code
5823@kindex dump binary
5824@kindex append binary
5825@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5826Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5827raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5828
5829@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5830Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5831raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5832
5833@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5834Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5835
5836@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5837Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5838
5839@kindex dump ihex
5840@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5841Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5842intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5843
5844@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5845Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5846
5847@kindex dump srec
5848@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5849Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5850srec format file @var{filename}.
5851
5852@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5853Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5854
5855@kindex dump tekhex
5856@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5857Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5858tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5859
5860@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5861Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5862
42f9b0a5 5863@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5864Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5865command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5866raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5867@var{binary} after the filename.
5868
5869If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5870contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5871they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5872a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5873from that location.
5874
5875If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5876file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5877These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5878the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5879
5880@end table
5881
e2e0bcd1
JB
5882@node Macros
5883@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
5884
5885Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
5886``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
5887@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
5888the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
5889where it was defined.
5890
5891You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
5892with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
5893include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
5894with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
5895
5896A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
5897and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
5898points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
5899no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
5900uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
5901@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
5902see @ref{List}.
5903
5904At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
5905token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
5906variable-arity macros.
5907
5908Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
5909macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
5910the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
5911
5912@table @code
5913
5914@kindex macro expand
5915@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
5916@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
5917@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
5918@item macro expand @var{expression}
5919@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
5920Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
5921@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
5922not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
5923it can be any string of tokens.
5924
5925@kindex macro expand-once
5926@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
5927@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
5928@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
5929expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
5930@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
5931left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
5932particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
5933expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
5934parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
5935can be any string of tokens.
5936
475b0867 5937@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
5938@cindex macro definition, showing
5939@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 5940@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
5941Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
5942source location where that definition was established.
5943
5944@kindex macro define
5945@cindex user-defined macros
5946@cindex defining macros interactively
5947@cindex macros, user-defined
5948@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
5949@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
5950@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
5951preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
5952by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
5953command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
5954second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
5955given in @var{arglist}.
5956
5957A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
5958evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
5959undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
5960definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
5961well as any previous user-supplied definition.
5962
5963@kindex macro undef
5964@item macro undef @var{macro}
5965@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
5966definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
5967definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
5968above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
5969debugged.
5970
5971@end table
5972
5973@cindex macros, example of debugging with
5974Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
5975show our source files:
5976
5977@smallexample
5978$ cat sample.c
5979#include <stdio.h>
5980#include "sample.h"
5981
5982#define M 42
5983#define ADD(x) (M + x)
5984
5985main ()
5986@{
5987#define N 28
5988 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
5989#undef N
5990 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
5991#define N 1729
5992 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
5993@}
5994$ cat sample.h
5995#define Q <
5996$
5997@end smallexample
5998
5999Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6000We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6001compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6002information.
6003
6004@smallexample
6005$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6006$
6007@end smallexample
6008
6009Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6010
6011@smallexample
6012$ gdb -nw sample
6013GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6014Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6015GDB is free software, @dots{}
6016(gdb)
6017@end smallexample
6018
6019We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6020program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6021to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6022
6023@smallexample
6024(gdb) list main
60253
60264 #define M 42
60275 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
60286
60297 main ()
60308 @{
60319 #define N 28
603210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
603311 #undef N
603412 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6035(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6036Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6037#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6038(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6039Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6040 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6041#define Q <
6042(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6043expands to: (42 + 1)
6044(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6045expands to: once (M + 1)
6046(gdb)
6047@end smallexample
6048
6049In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6050the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6051@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6052which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6053
6054Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6055the source line of the current stack frame:
6056
6057@smallexample
6058(gdb) break main
6059Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6060(gdb) run
6061Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6062
6063Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
606410 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6065(gdb)
6066@end smallexample
6067
6068At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6069
6070@smallexample
475b0867 6071(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6072Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6073#define N 28
6074(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6075expands to: 28 < 42
6076(gdb) print N Q M
6077$1 = 1
6078(gdb)
6079@end smallexample
6080
6081As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6082give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6083thereof) in force at each point:
6084
6085@smallexample
6086(gdb) next
6087Hello, world!
608812 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6089(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6090The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6091at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6092(gdb) next
6093We're so creative.
609414 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6095(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6096Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6097#define N 1729
6098(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6099expands to: 1729 < 42
6100(gdb) print N Q M
6101$2 = 0
6102(gdb)
6103@end smallexample
6104
6105
b37052ae
EZ
6106@node Tracepoints
6107@chapter Tracepoints
6108@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6109@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6110
6111@cindex tracepoints
6112In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6113the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6114anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6115depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6116might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6117fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6118to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6119
6120Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6121specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6122arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6123Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6124those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6125expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6126for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6127a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6128in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6129values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6130unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6131
6132The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6133targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6134to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6135stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6136tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6137
6138This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6139
6140@menu
6141* Set Tracepoints::
6142* Analyze Collected Data::
6143* Tracepoint Variables::
6144@end menu
6145
6146@node Set Tracepoints
6147@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6148
6149Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6150tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6151tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6152breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6153one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6154tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6155work on.
6156
6157For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6158of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6159it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6160local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6161commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6162tracepoint was hit.
6163
6164This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6165conditions and actions.
6166
6167@menu
6168* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6169* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6170* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6171* Tracepoint Actions::
6172* Listing Tracepoints::
6173* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6174@end menu
6175
6176@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6177@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6178
6179@table @code
6180@cindex set tracepoint
6181@kindex trace
6182@item trace
6183The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6184Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6185the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6186defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6187debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6188program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6189doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6190cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6191running.
6192
6193Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6194
6195@smallexample
6196(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6197
6198(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6199
6200(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6201
6202(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6203
6204(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6205@end smallexample
6206
6207@noindent
6208You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6209
6210@vindex $tpnum
6211@cindex last tracepoint number
6212@cindex recent tracepoint number
6213@cindex tracepoint number
6214The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6215of the most recently set tracepoint.
6216
6217@kindex delete tracepoint
6218@cindex tracepoint deletion
6219@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6220Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6221default is to delete all tracepoints.
6222
6223Examples:
6224
6225@smallexample
6226(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6227
6228(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6229@end smallexample
6230
6231@noindent
6232You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6233@end table
6234
6235@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6236@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6237
6238@table @code
6239@kindex disable tracepoint
6240@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6241Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6242@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6243the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6244a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6245
6246@kindex enable tracepoint
6247@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6248Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6249tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6250run.
6251@end table
6252
6253@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6254@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6255
6256@table @code
6257@kindex passcount
6258@cindex tracepoint pass count
6259@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6260Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6261automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6262@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6263the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6264@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6265passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6266given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6267user.
6268
6269Examples:
6270
6271@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6272(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6273@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6274
6275(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6276@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6277(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6278(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6279(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6280(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6281(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6282(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6283@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6284@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6285@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6286@end smallexample
6287@end table
6288
6289@node Tracepoint Actions
6290@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6291
6292@table @code
6293@kindex actions
6294@cindex tracepoint actions
6295@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6296This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6297tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6298specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6299recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6300@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6301actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6302terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6303far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6304@code{while-stepping}.
6305
6306@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6307To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6308and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6309
6310@smallexample
6311(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6312
6826cf00 6313(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6314
6826cf00 6315(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6316@end smallexample
6317
6318In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6319commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6320hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6321following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6322followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6323@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6324@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6325@code{end} command.
6326
6327@smallexample
6328(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6329(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6330Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6331> collect bar,baz
6332> collect $regs
6333> while-stepping 12
6334 > collect $fp, $sp
6335 > end
6336end
6337@end smallexample
6338
6339@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6340@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6341Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6342This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6343In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6344special arguments are supported:
6345
6346@table @code
6347@item $regs
6348collect all registers
6349
6350@item $args
6351collect all function arguments
6352
6353@item $locals
6354collect all local variables.
6355@end table
6356
6357You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6358with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6359arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6360
f5c37c66
EZ
6361The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6362particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6363
b37052ae
EZ
6364@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6365@item while-stepping @var{n}
6366Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6367new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6368followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6369its own @code{end} command):
6370
6371@smallexample
6372> while-stepping 12
6373 > collect $regs, myglobal
6374 > end
6375>
6376@end smallexample
6377
6378@noindent
6379You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6380@code{stepping}.
6381@end table
6382
6383@node Listing Tracepoints
6384@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6385
6386@table @code
6387@kindex info tracepoints
6388@cindex information about tracepoints
6389@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6390Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6391a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6392defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6393shown:
6394
6395@itemize @bullet
6396@item
6397its number
6398@item
6399whether it is enabled or disabled
6400@item
6401its address
6402@item
6403its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6404@item
6405its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6406@item
6407where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6408@item
6409its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6410@end itemize
6411
6412@smallexample
6413(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6414Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
64151 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
64162 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
64173 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6418(@value{GDBP})
6419@end smallexample
6420
6421@noindent
6422This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6423@end table
6424
6425@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6426@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6427
6428@table @code
6429@kindex tstart
6430@cindex start a new trace experiment
6431@cindex collected data discarded
6432@item tstart
6433This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6434begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6435the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6436experiment.
6437
6438@kindex tstop
6439@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6440@item tstop
6441This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6442stops collecting data.
6443
6444@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6445automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6446(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6447
6448@kindex tstatus
6449@cindex status of trace data collection
6450@cindex trace experiment, status of
6451@item tstatus
6452This command displays the status of the current trace data
6453collection.
6454@end table
6455
6456Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6457
6458@smallexample
6459(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6460(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6461Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6462> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6463> while-stepping 11
6464 > collect $regs
6465 > end
6466> end
6467(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6468 [time passes @dots{}]
6469(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6470@end smallexample
6471
6472
6473@node Analyze Collected Data
6474@section Using the collected data
6475
6476After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6477for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6478collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6479snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6480consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6481examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6482specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6483snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6484registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6485rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6486debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6487(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6488behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6489when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6490the buffer will fail.
6491
6492@menu
6493* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6494* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6495* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6496@end menu
6497
6498@node tfind
6499@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6500
6501@kindex tfind
6502@cindex select trace snapshot
6503@cindex find trace snapshot
6504The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6505@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6506counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6507snapshot is selected.
6508
6509Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6510
6511@table @code
6512@item tfind start
6513Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6514@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6515
6516@item tfind none
6517Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6518
6519@item tfind end
6520Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6521
6522@item tfind
6523No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6524
6525@item tfind -
6526Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6527retracing earlier steps.
6528
6529@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6530Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6531proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6532argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6533for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6534
6535@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6536Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6537program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6538snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6539snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6540
6541@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6542Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6543addresses.
6544
6545@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6546Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6547@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6548
6549@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6550Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6551the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6552that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6553trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6554next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6555@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6556stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6557@end table
6558
6559The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6560designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6561instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6562snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6563trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6564simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6565snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6566@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6567The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6568for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6569no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6570(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6571no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6572tracepoint as the current one.
6573
6574In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6575these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6576scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6577you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6578registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6579
6580@smallexample
6581(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6582(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6583> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6584 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6585> tfind
6586> end
6587
6588Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6589Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6590Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6591Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6592Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6593Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6594Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6595Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6596Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6597Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6598Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6599@end smallexample
6600
6601Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6602the buffer:
6603
6604@smallexample
6605(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6606(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6607> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6608> tfind line
6609> end
6610
6611Frame 0, X = 1
6612Frame 7, X = 2
6613Frame 13, X = 255
6614@end smallexample
6615
6616@node tdump
6617@subsection @code{tdump}
6618@kindex tdump
6619@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6620@cindex tracepoint data, display
6621
6622This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6623the current trace snapshot.
6624
6625@smallexample
6626(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6627(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6628Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6629> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6630> end
6631
6632(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6633
6634(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6635#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6636at gdb_test.c:444
6637444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6638
6639(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6640Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6641d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6642d1 0x18 24
6643d2 0x80 128
6644d3 0x33 51
6645d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6646d5 0x22 34
6647d6 0xe0 224
6648d7 0x380035 3670069
6649a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6650a1 0x3000668 50333288
6651a2 0x100 256
6652a3 0x322000 3284992
6653a4 0x3000698 50333336
6654a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6655fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6656sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6657ps 0x0 0
6658pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6659fpcontrol 0x0 0
6660fpstatus 0x0 0
6661fpiaddr 0x0 0
6662p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6663p1 = (void *) 0x11
6664p2 = (void *) 0x22
6665p3 = (void *) 0x33
6666p4 = (void *) 0x44
6667p5 = (void *) 0x55
6668p6 = (void *) 0x66
6669gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6670
6671(@value{GDBP})
6672@end smallexample
6673
6674@node save-tracepoints
6675@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6676@kindex save-tracepoints
6677@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6678
6679This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6680their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6681suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6682tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6683Files}).
6684
6685@node Tracepoint Variables
6686@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6687@cindex tracepoint variables
6688@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6689
6690@table @code
6691@vindex $trace_frame
6692@item (int) $trace_frame
6693The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6694snapshot is selected.
6695
6696@vindex $tracepoint
6697@item (int) $tracepoint
6698The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6699
6700@vindex $trace_line
6701@item (int) $trace_line
6702The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6703
6704@vindex $trace_file
6705@item (char []) $trace_file
6706The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6707
6708@vindex $trace_func
6709@item (char []) $trace_func
6710The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6711@end table
6712
6713Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6714use @code{output} instead.
6715
6716Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6717stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6718data.
6719
6720@smallexample
6721(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6722
6723(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6724> output $trace_file
6725> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6726> tfind
6727> end
6728@end smallexample
6729
df0cd8c5
JB
6730@node Overlays
6731@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6732@cindex overlays
6733
6734If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6735memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6736problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6737use overlays.
6738
6739@menu
6740* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6741* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6742* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6743 mapped by asking the inferior.
6744* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6745@end menu
6746
6747@node How Overlays Work
6748@section How Overlays Work
6749@cindex mapped overlays
6750@cindex unmapped overlays
6751@cindex load address, overlay's
6752@cindex mapped address
6753@cindex overlay area
6754
6755Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
6756kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
6757other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
6758management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
6759adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
6760
6761One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
6762independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
6763@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
6764their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
6765instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
6766largest overlay as well.
6767
6768Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
6769overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
6770for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
6771there.
6772
c928edc0
AC
6773@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
6774@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
6775@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
6776
474c8240 6777@smallexample
df0cd8c5 6778@group
c928edc0
AC
6779 Data Instruction Larger
6780Address Space Address Space Address Space
6781+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
6782| | | | | |
6783+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
6784| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
6785| variables | | program | | +-----------+
6786| and heap | | | | | |
6787+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
6788| | +-----------+ | | | load address
6789+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
6790 | | | | | |
6791 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
6792 address | | | | | |
6793 | overlay | <-' | | |
6794 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
6795 | | <---. | | load address
6796 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
6797 | | | |
6798 +-----------+ | |
6799 +-----------+
6800 | |
6801 +-----------+
6802
6803 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 6804@end group
474c8240 6805@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 6806
c928edc0
AC
6807The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
6808and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
6809its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
6810Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
6811may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
6812data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
6813program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
6814program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
6815
6816An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
6817@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
6818instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
6819in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
6820is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
6821the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
6822called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
6823
6824Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
6825program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
6826global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
6827
6828@itemize @bullet
6829
6830@item
6831Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
6832must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
6833return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
6834overlay, and your program will probably crash.
6835
6836@item
6837If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
6838will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
6839your program's performance.
6840
6841@item
6842The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
6843overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
6844mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
6845and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
6846You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
6847addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
6848ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
6849
6850@item
6851The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
6852to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
6853instruction and data spaces.
6854
6855@end itemize
6856
6857The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
6858improved in many ways:
6859
6860@itemize @bullet
6861
6862@item
6863If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
6864hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
6865contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
6866This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
6867area in the usual way.
6868
6869@item
6870If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
6871overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
6872
6873@item
6874You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
6875general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
6876code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
6877return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
6878the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
6879must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
6880different data overlay into the same mapped area.
6881
6882@end itemize
6883
6884
6885@node Overlay Commands
6886@section Overlay Commands
6887
6888To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
6889correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
6890virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
6891mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
6892@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
6893variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
6894
6895@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
6896you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
6897
6898@table @code
6899@item overlay off
6900@kindex overlay off
6901Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
6902disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
6903always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
6904overlay support is disabled.
6905
6906@item overlay manual
6907@kindex overlay manual
6908@cindex manual overlay debugging
6909Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6910relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
6911using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
6912commands described below.
6913
6914@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
6915@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
6916@kindex overlay map-overlay
6917@cindex map an overlay
6918Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
6919be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
6920overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
6921functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
6922that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
6923@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
6924
6925@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
6926@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
6927@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
6928@cindex unmap an overlay
6929Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
6930must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
6931When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
6932overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
6933
6934@item overlay auto
6935@kindex overlay auto
6936Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6937consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
6938to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
6939Overlay Debugging}.
6940
6941@item overlay load-target
6942@itemx overlay load
6943@kindex overlay load-target
6944@cindex reloading the overlay table
6945Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
6946re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
6947stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
6948overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
6949useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
6950
6951@item overlay list-overlays
6952@itemx overlay list
6953@cindex listing mapped overlays
6954Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
6955addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
6956
6957@end table
6958
6959Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
6960of the function the address falls in:
6961
474c8240 6962@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6963(gdb) print main
6964$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 6965@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6966@noindent
6967When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
6968unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
6969asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
6970unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
6971
474c8240 6972@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6973(gdb) overlay list
6974No sections are mapped.
6975(gdb) print foo
6976$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 6977@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6978@noindent
6979When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
6980name normally:
6981
474c8240 6982@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6983(gdb) overlay list
6984Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
6985 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
6986(gdb) print foo
6987$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 6988@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
6989
6990When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
6991address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
6992overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
6993@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
6994code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
6995
6996@itemize @bullet
6997@item
6998@cindex breakpoints in overlays
6999@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7000You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7001@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7002@item
7003@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7004unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7005overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7006you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7007breakpoints properly.
7008@end itemize
7009
7010
7011@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7012@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7013@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7014
7015@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7016are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7017inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7018@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7019looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7020current state of the overlays.
7021
7022Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7023@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7024
7025@table @asis
7026
7027@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7028This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7029
474c8240 7030@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7031struct
7032@{
7033 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7034 unsigned long vma;
7035
7036 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7037 unsigned long size;
7038
7039 /* The overlay's load address. */
7040 unsigned long lma;
7041
7042 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7043 zero otherwise. */
7044 unsigned long mapped;
7045@}
474c8240 7046@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7047
7048@item @code{_novlys}:
7049This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7050number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7051
7052@end table
7053
7054To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7055looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7056@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7057executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7058the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7059currently mapped.
7060
81d46470 7061In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7062@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7063will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7064calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7065will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7066are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7067in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7068overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7069are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7070
7071@node Overlay Sample Program
7072@section Overlay Sample Program
7073@cindex overlay example program
7074
7075When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7076at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7077addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7078Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7079since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7080architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7081portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7082
7083However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7084program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7085suite. The program consists of the following files from
7086@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7087
7088@table @file
7089@item overlays.c
7090The main program file.
7091@item ovlymgr.c
7092A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7093@item foo.c
7094@itemx bar.c
7095@itemx baz.c
7096@itemx grbx.c
7097Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7098@item d10v.ld
7099@itemx m32r.ld
7100Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7101and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7102@end table
7103
7104You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7105cross-compiler like this:
7106
474c8240 7107@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7108$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7109$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7110$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7111$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7112$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7113$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7114$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7115 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7116@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7117
7118The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7119you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7120target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7121
7122
6d2ebf8b 7123@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7124@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7125@cindex languages
7126
c906108c
SS
7127Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7128rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7129dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7130Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7131represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7132@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7133
7134@cindex working language
7135Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7136allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7137native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7138consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7139language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7140language}.
7141
7142@menu
7143* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7144* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7145* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7146* Support:: Supported languages
7147@end menu
7148
6d2ebf8b 7149@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7150@section Switching between source languages
7151
7152There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7153set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7154@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7155defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7156used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7157are printed, etc.
7158
7159In addition to the working language, every source file that
7160@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7161file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7162source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7163language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7164controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7165show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7166set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7167set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7168Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7169
7170This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7171as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7172another language. In that case, make the
7173program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7174@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7175program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7176
7177@menu
7178* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7179* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7180* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7181@end menu
7182
6d2ebf8b 7183@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7184@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7185
7186If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7187@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7188
7189@table @file
7190
7191@item .c
7192C source file
7193
7194@item .C
7195@itemx .cc
7196@itemx .cp
7197@itemx .cpp
7198@itemx .cxx
7199@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7200C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7201
7202@item .f
7203@itemx .F
7204Fortran source file
7205
db034ac5
AC
7206@c OBSOLETE @item .ch
7207@c OBSOLETE @itemx .c186
7208@c OBSOLETE @itemx .c286
7209@c OBSOLETE CHILL source file
c906108c 7210
c906108c
SS
7211@item .mod
7212Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7213
7214@item .s
7215@itemx .S
7216Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7217@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7218@end table
7219
7220In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7221extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7222
6d2ebf8b 7223@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7224@subsection Setting the working language
7225
7226If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7227expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7228your program.
7229
7230@kindex set language
7231If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7232command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7233a language, such as
c906108c 7234@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7235For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7236
c906108c
SS
7237Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7238language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7239to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7240source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7241languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7242source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7243command such as:
7244
474c8240 7245@smallexample
c906108c 7246print a = b + c
474c8240 7247@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7248
7249@noindent
7250might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7251@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7252printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7253@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7254
6d2ebf8b 7255@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7256@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7257
7258To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7259@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7260then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7261frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7262working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7263frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7264or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7265does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7266not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7267
7268This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7269entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7270written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7271a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7272case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7273
6d2ebf8b 7274@node Show
c906108c 7275@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7276
7277The following commands help you find out which language is the
7278working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7279
7280@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7281@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7282@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7283@table @code
7284@item show language
7285Display the current working language. This is the
7286language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7287build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7288
7289@item info frame
5d161b24 7290Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7291working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7292@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7293information listed here.
7294
7295@item info source
7296Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7297@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7298information listed here.
7299@end table
7300
7301In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7302not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7303with a language explicitly:
7304
7305@kindex set extension-language
7306@kindex info extensions
7307@table @code
7308@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7309Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7310the source language @var{language}.
7311
7312@item info extensions
7313List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7314@end table
7315
6d2ebf8b 7316@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7317@section Type and range checking
7318
7319@quotation
7320@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7321checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7322section documents the intended facilities.
7323@end quotation
7324@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7325
7326Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7327errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7328checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7329sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7330these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7331by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7332errors when your program is running.
7333
7334@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7335Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7336can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7337the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7338@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7339your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7340for the default settings of supported languages.
7341
7342@menu
7343* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7344* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7345@end menu
7346
7347@cindex type checking
7348@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7349@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7350@subsection An overview of type checking
7351
7352Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7353arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7354otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7355errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7356
7357@smallexample
73581 + 2 @result{} 3
7359@exdent but
7360@error{} 1 + 2.3
7361@end smallexample
7362
7363The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7364type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7365
5d161b24
DB
7366For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7367@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7368to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7369or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7370but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7371these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7372also issues a warning.
7373
5d161b24
DB
7374Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7375related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7376For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7377a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7378with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7379the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7380
7381Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7382instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7383operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7384represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7385operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7386details on specific languages.
7387
7388@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7389
d4f3574e 7390@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7391@kindex set check type
7392@kindex show check type
7393@table @code
7394@item set check type auto
7395Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7396@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7397each language.
7398
7399@item set check type on
7400@itemx set check type off
7401Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7402current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7403match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7404evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7405message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7406
7407@item set check type warn
7408Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7409evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7410be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7411numbers and structures.
7412
7413@item show type
5d161b24 7414Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7415is setting it automatically.
7416@end table
7417
7418@cindex range checking
7419@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7420@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7421@subsection An overview of range checking
7422
7423In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7424bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7425checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7426computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7427not exceed the bounds of the array.
7428
7429For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7430@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7431always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7432warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7433
7434A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7435array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7436of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7437error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7438result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7439the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7440
474c8240 7441@smallexample
c906108c 7442@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7443@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7444
7445This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7446specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7447Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7448
7449@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7450
d4f3574e 7451@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7452@kindex set check range
7453@kindex show check range
7454@table @code
7455@item set check range auto
7456Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7457@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7458each language.
7459
7460@item set check range on
7461@itemx set check range off
7462Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7463current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7464match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7465then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7466
7467@item set check range warn
7468Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7469but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7470expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7471memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7472systems).
7473
7474@item show range
7475Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7476being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7477@end table
c906108c 7478
6d2ebf8b 7479@node Support
c906108c 7480@section Supported languages
c906108c 7481
db034ac5
AC
7482@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java,
7483@c OBSOLETE Chill,
7484assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7485@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7486Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7487language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7488and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7489,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7490language.
7491
7492The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7493supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7494tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7495@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7496formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7497books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7498language reference or tutorial.
7499
c906108c 7500@menu
b37052ae 7501* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7502* Modula-2:: Modula-2
db034ac5 7503@c OBSOLETE * Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
7504@end menu
7505
6d2ebf8b 7506@node C
b37052ae 7507@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7508
b37052ae
EZ
7509@cindex C and C@t{++}
7510@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7511
b37052ae 7512Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7513to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7514together.
7515
41afff9a
EZ
7516@cindex C@t{++}
7517@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7518@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7519The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7520compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7521effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7522C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7523compiler (@code{aCC}).
7524
b37052ae 7525For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7526format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7527command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7528@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7529CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7530
c906108c 7531@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7532* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7533* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7534* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7535* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7536* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7537* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7538* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7539@end menu
c906108c 7540
6d2ebf8b 7541@node C Operators
b37052ae 7542@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7543
b37052ae 7544@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7545
7546Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7547@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7548often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7549
b37052ae 7550For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7551
7552@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7553
c906108c 7554@item
c906108c 7555@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7556specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7557
7558@item
d4f3574e
SS
7559@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7560@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7561
7562@item
53a5351d 7563@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7564
7565@item
7566@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7567
c906108c
SS
7568@end itemize
7569
7570@noindent
7571The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7572in order of increasing precedence:
7573
7574@table @code
7575@item ,
7576The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7577are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7578expression being the last expression evaluated.
7579
7580@item =
7581Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7582assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7583
7584@item @var{op}=
7585Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7586and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7587@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7588@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7589@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7590
7591@item ?:
7592The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7593of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7594integral type.
7595
7596@item ||
7597Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7598
7599@item &&
7600Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7601
7602@item |
7603Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7604
7605@item ^
7606Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7607
7608@item &
7609Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7610
7611@item ==@r{, }!=
7612Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7613expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7614
7615@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7616Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7617Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7618and non-zero for true.
7619
7620@item <<@r{, }>>
7621left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7622
7623@item @@
7624The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7625
7626@item +@r{, }-
7627Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7628pointer types.
7629
7630@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7631Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7632defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7633integral types.
7634
7635@item ++@r{, }--
7636Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7637operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7638when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7639operation takes place.
7640
7641@item *
7642Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7643@code{++}.
7644
7645@item &
7646Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7647
b37052ae
EZ
7648For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7649allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7650(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7651where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7652stored.
c906108c
SS
7653
7654@item -
7655Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7656precedence as @code{++}.
7657
7658@item !
7659Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7660@code{++}.
7661
7662@item ~
7663Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7664@code{++}.
7665
7666
7667@item .@r{, }->
7668Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7669@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7670pointer based on the stored type information.
7671Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7672
c906108c
SS
7673@item .*@r{, }->*
7674Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7675
7676@item []
7677Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7678@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7679
7680@item ()
7681Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7682
c906108c 7683@item ::
b37052ae 7684C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7685and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7686
7687@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7688Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7689(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7690above.
c906108c
SS
7691@end table
7692
c906108c
SS
7693If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7694attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7695predefined meaning.
c906108c 7696
c906108c 7697@menu
5d161b24 7698* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7699@end menu
7700
6d2ebf8b 7701@node C Constants
b37052ae 7702@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7703
b37052ae 7704@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7705
b37052ae 7706@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7707following ways:
c906108c
SS
7708
7709@itemize @bullet
7710@item
7711Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
7712specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7713by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
7714@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7715@code{long} value.
7716
7717@item
7718Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7719point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7720exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7721@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7722sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7723A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7724@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7725the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7726a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7727constant.
c906108c
SS
7728
7729@item
7730Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7731integral equivalents.
7732
7733@item
7734Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7735(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7736(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7737be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7738the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7739of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7740@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7741@samp{\n} for newline.
7742
7743@item
96a2c332
SS
7744String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7745double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7746above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7747a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7748characters.
c906108c
SS
7749
7750@item
7751Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7752to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7753
7754@item
7755Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7756and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7757integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7758and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7759@end itemize
7760
c906108c 7761@menu
5d161b24
DB
7762* C plus plus expressions::
7763* C Defaults::
7764* C Checks::
c906108c 7765
5d161b24 7766* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
7767@end menu
7768
6d2ebf8b 7769@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
7770@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
7771
7772@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
7773@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
7774
7775@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
7776@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
7777@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
7778@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
7779@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
7780@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
7781@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
7782@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
7783@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7784@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
7785@c periodically whether this has happened...
7786@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
7787@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
7788proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
7789additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
7790special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
7791@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
7792symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
7793you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
7794extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 7795@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7796support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
7797@end quotation
c906108c
SS
7798
7799@enumerate
7800
7801@cindex member functions
7802@item
7803Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
7804
474c8240 7805@smallexample
c906108c 7806count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 7807@end smallexample
c906108c 7808
41afff9a 7809@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 7810@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7811@item
7812While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
7813expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
7814that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 7815pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 7816
c906108c 7817@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 7818@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 7819@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7820@item
7821You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 7822call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
7823perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
7824calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
7825in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
7826default arguments.
7827
7828It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7829promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7830class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7831functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7832number of function arguments.
7833
7834Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7835@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 7836,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 7837
d4f3574e 7838You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
7839explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7840@smallexample
7841p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7842@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7843
c906108c 7844The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 7845see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 7846
c906108c
SS
7847@cindex reference declarations
7848@item
b37052ae
EZ
7849@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7850them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7851dereferenced.
7852
7853In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7854reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7855avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7856The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7857you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7858
7859@item
b37052ae 7860@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7861expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7862one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7863necessary, for example in an expression like
7864@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7865resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7866debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7867@end enumerate
7868
b37052ae 7869In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7870calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7871objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7872invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7873
6d2ebf8b 7874@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7875@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7876
b37052ae 7877@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7878
c906108c
SS
7879If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7880both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7881C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7882selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7883
7884If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7885recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7886@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7887these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7888@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7889for further details.
7890
c906108c
SS
7891@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7892@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7893@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7894
6d2ebf8b 7895@node C Checks
b37052ae 7896@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7897
b37052ae 7898@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7899
b37052ae 7900By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7901is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7902considers two variables type equivalent if:
7903
7904@itemize @bullet
7905@item
7906The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7907enumerated tag.
7908
7909@item
7910The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7911declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7912
7913@ignore
7914@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7915@c FIXME--beers?
7916@item
7917The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7918declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7919compilers.)
7920@end ignore
7921@end itemize
7922
7923Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7924indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7925that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7926
6d2ebf8b 7927@node Debugging C
c906108c 7928@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7929
7930The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7931the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7932inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7933appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7934
7935The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7936with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7937,Expressions}.
7938
c906108c 7939@menu
5d161b24 7940* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7941@end menu
7942
6d2ebf8b 7943@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7944@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7945
b37052ae 7946@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7947
b37052ae
EZ
7948Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7949designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7950
7951@table @code
7952@cindex break in overloaded functions
7953@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7954When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7955@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7956you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7957
b37052ae 7958@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7959@item rbreak @var{regex}
7960Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7961breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7962classes.
7963@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7964
b37052ae 7965@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7966@item catch throw
7967@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7968Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7969Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7970
7971@cindex inheritance
7972@item ptype @var{typename}
7973Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7974@var{typename}.
7975@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7976
b37052ae 7977@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7978@item set print demangle
7979@itemx show print demangle
7980@itemx set print asm-demangle
7981@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7982Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7983displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7984@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7985
7986@item set print object
7987@itemx show print object
7988Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7989@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7990
7991@item set print vtbl
7992@itemx show print vtbl
7993Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7994@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7995(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7996ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7997
7998@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7999@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8000@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8001Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8002is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8003and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8004using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8005expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8006message.
8007
8008@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8009Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8010overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8011chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8012symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8013overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8014searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8015argument types.
c906108c
SS
8016
8017@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8018You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8019the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8020@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8021also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8022available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8023@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8024@end table
c906108c 8025
6d2ebf8b 8026@node Modula-2
c906108c 8027@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8028
d4f3574e 8029@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8030
8031The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8032output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8033developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8034attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8035to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8036table.
8037
8038@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8039@menu
8040* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8041* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8042* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8043* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8044* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8045* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8046* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8047* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8048@end menu
8049
6d2ebf8b 8050@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8051@subsubsection Operators
8052@cindex Modula-2 operators
8053
8054Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8055@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8056often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8057following definitions hold:
8058
8059@itemize @bullet
8060
8061@item
8062@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8063their subranges.
8064
8065@item
8066@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8067
8068@item
8069@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8070
8071@item
8072@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8073@var{type}}.
8074
8075@item
8076@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8077
8078@item
8079@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8080
8081@item
8082@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8083@end itemize
8084
8085@noindent
8086The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8087increasing precedence:
8088
8089@table @code
8090@item ,
8091Function argument or array index separator.
8092
8093@item :=
8094Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8095@var{value}.
8096
8097@item <@r{, }>
8098Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8099types.
8100
8101@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8102Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8103on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8104set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8105
8106@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8107Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8108Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8109available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8110comment character.
8111
8112@item IN
8113Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8114Same precedence as @code{<}.
8115
8116@item OR
8117Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8118
8119@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8120Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8121
8122@item @@
8123The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8124
8125@item +@r{, }-
8126Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8127and difference on set types.
8128
8129@item *
8130Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8131on set types.
8132
8133@item /
8134Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8135types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8136
8137@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8138Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8139precedence as @code{*}.
8140
8141@item -
8142Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8143
8144@item ^
8145Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8146
8147@item NOT
8148Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8149@code{^}.
8150
8151@item .
8152@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8153precedence as @code{^}.
8154
8155@item []
8156Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8157
8158@item ()
8159Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8160as @code{^}.
8161
8162@item ::@r{, }.
8163@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8164@end table
8165
8166@quotation
8167@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8168treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8169@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8170@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8171@end quotation
8172
cb51c4e0 8173
6d2ebf8b 8174@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8175@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8176@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8177
8178Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8179In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8180
8181@table @var
8182
8183@item a
8184represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8185
8186@item c
8187represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8188
8189@item i
8190represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8191
8192@item m
8193represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8194same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8195be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8196
8197@item n
8198represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8199
8200@item r
8201represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8202
8203@item t
8204represents a type.
8205
8206@item v
8207represents a variable.
8208
8209@item x
8210represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8211explanation of the function for details.
8212@end table
8213
8214All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8215
8216@table @code
8217@item ABS(@var{n})
8218Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8219
8220@item CAP(@var{c})
8221If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8222equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8223
8224@item CHR(@var{i})
8225Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8226
8227@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8228Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8229
8230@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8231Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8232new value.
8233
8234@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8235Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8236set.
8237
8238@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8239Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8240
8241@item HIGH(@var{a})
8242Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8243
8244@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8245Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8246
8247@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8248Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8249new value.
8250
8251@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8252Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8253there. Returns the new set.
8254
8255@item MAX(@var{t})
8256Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8257
8258@item MIN(@var{t})
8259Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8260
8261@item ODD(@var{i})
8262Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8263
8264@item ORD(@var{x})
8265Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8266value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8267@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8268integral, character and enumerated types.
8269
8270@item SIZE(@var{x})
8271Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8272
8273@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8274Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8275
8276@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8277Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8278@end table
8279
8280@quotation
8281@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8282@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8283an error.
8284@end quotation
8285
8286@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8287@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8288@subsubsection Constants
8289
8290@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8291ways:
8292
8293@itemize @bullet
8294
8295@item
8296Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8297expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8298rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8299trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8300
8301@item
8302Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8303decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8304then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8305@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8306digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8307digits.
8308
8309@item
8310Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8311like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8312also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8313followed by a @samp{C}.
8314
8315@item
8316String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8317pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8318Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8319Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8320sequences.
8321
8322@item
8323Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8324
8325@item
8326Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8327@code{FALSE}.
8328
8329@item
8330Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8331
8332@item
8333Set constants are not yet supported.
8334@end itemize
8335
6d2ebf8b 8336@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8337@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8338@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8339
8340If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8341both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8342Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8343selected the working language.
8344
8345If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8346code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8347working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8348the language automatically}, for further details.
8349
6d2ebf8b 8350@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8351@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8352@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8353
8354A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8355This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8356
8357@itemize @bullet
8358@item
8359Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8360integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8361debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8362pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8363through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8364returned a pointer.)
8365
8366@item
8367C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8368non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8369escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8370printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8371
8372@item
8373The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8374argument.
8375
8376@item
8377All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8378@end itemize
8379
6d2ebf8b 8380@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8381@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8382@cindex Modula-2 checks
8383
8384@quotation
8385@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8386range checking.
8387@end quotation
8388@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8389
8390@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8391
8392@itemize @bullet
8393@item
8394They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8395@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8396
8397@item
8398They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8399@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8400@end itemize
8401
8402As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8403whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8404
8405Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8406index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8407
6d2ebf8b 8408@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8409@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8410@cindex scope
41afff9a 8411@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8412@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8413@ifinfo
41afff9a 8414@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8415@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8416@end ifinfo
8417@iftex
41afff9a 8418@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8419@end iftex
8420
8421There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8422(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8423similar syntax:
8424
474c8240 8425@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8426
8427@var{module} . @var{id}
8428@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8429@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8430
8431@noindent
8432where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8433@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8434identifier within your program, except another module.
8435
8436Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8437specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8438found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8439enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8440
8441Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8442the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8443definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8444an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8445module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8446@var{module}.
8447
6d2ebf8b 8448@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8449@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8450
8451Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8452Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8453specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8454@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8455apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8456analogue in Modula-2.
8457
8458The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8459with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8460intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8461created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8462address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8463@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8464
8465@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8466In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8467interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8468
db034ac5
AC
8469@c OBSOLETE @node Chill
8470@c OBSOLETE @subsection Chill
8471@c OBSOLETE
8472@c OBSOLETE The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
8473@c OBSOLETE from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
8474@c OBSOLETE supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8475@c OBSOLETE likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8476@c OBSOLETE table.
8477@c OBSOLETE
8478@c OBSOLETE @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8479@c OBSOLETE @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8480@c OBSOLETE This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
8481@c OBSOLETE of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8482@c OBSOLETE
8483@c OBSOLETE @menu
8484@c OBSOLETE * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8485@c OBSOLETE * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
8486@c OBSOLETE * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
8487@c OBSOLETE * Chill type and range checks::
8488@c OBSOLETE * Chill defaults::
8489@c OBSOLETE @end menu
8490@c OBSOLETE
8491@c OBSOLETE @node How modes are displayed
8492@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection How modes are displayed
8493@c OBSOLETE
8494@c OBSOLETE The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
8495@c OBSOLETE with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
8496@c OBSOLETE slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8497@c OBSOLETE provided modes are:
8498@c OBSOLETE
8499@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8500@c OBSOLETE @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
8501@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8502@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8503@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8504@c OBSOLETE @item
8505@c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8506@c OBSOLETE UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8507@c OBSOLETE @item
8508@c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
8509@c OBSOLETE @item
8510@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
8511@c OBSOLETE @item
8512@c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8513@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8514@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8515@c OBSOLETE type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8516@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8517@c OBSOLETE If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8518@c OBSOLETE @item
8519@c OBSOLETE @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8520@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8521@c OBSOLETE @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8522@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8523@c OBSOLETE where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8524@c OBSOLETE expression (e.g. set element names).
8525@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8526@c OBSOLETE
8527@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8528@c OBSOLETE A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
8529@c OBSOLETE the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
8530@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8531@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8532@c OBSOLETE type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8533@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8534@c OBSOLETE
8535@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8536@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8537@c OBSOLETE @item
8538@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
8539@c OBSOLETE followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8540@c OBSOLETE @item
8541@c OBSOLETE @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8542@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8543@c OBSOLETE
8544@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8545@c OBSOLETE The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8546@c OBSOLETE <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
8547@c OBSOLETE list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8548@c OBSOLETE the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
8549@c OBSOLETE all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8550@c OBSOLETE
8551@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8552@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8553@c OBSOLETE The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
8554@c OBSOLETE type, and is therefore not really of interest.
8555@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8556@c OBSOLETE
8557@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
8558@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8559@c OBSOLETE @item
8560@c OBSOLETE @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8561@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8562@c OBSOLETE @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8563@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8564@c OBSOLETE where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8565@c OBSOLETE @item
8566@c OBSOLETE @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8567@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8568@c OBSOLETE @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8569@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8570@c OBSOLETE where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
8571@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8572@c OBSOLETE
8573@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
8574@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8575@c OBSOLETE @item
8576@c OBSOLETE @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8577@c OBSOLETE @item
8578@c OBSOLETE @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8579@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8580@c OBSOLETE
8581@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8582@c OBSOLETE Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8583@c OBSOLETE
8584@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8585@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8586@c OBSOLETE @item
8587@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8588@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8589@c OBSOLETE @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8590@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8591@c OBSOLETE followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8592@c OBSOLETE mode
8593@c OBSOLETE @item
8594@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8595@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8596@c OBSOLETE @code{BOOLS(<string
8597@c OBSOLETE length>)}
8598@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8599@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8600@c OBSOLETE
8601@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8602@c OBSOLETE The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8603@c OBSOLETE followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8604@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8605@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8606@c OBSOLETE type = ARRAY (1:42)
8607@c OBSOLETE ARRAY (1:20)
8608@c OBSOLETE SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8609@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8610@c OBSOLETE
8611@c OBSOLETE @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
8612@c OBSOLETE The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
8613@c OBSOLETE list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8614@c OBSOLETE of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8615@c OBSOLETE OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
8616@c OBSOLETE of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8617@c OBSOLETE checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8618@c OBSOLETE always displays all variant fields.
8619@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8620@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8621@c OBSOLETE type = STRUCT (
8622@c OBSOLETE as x,
8623@c OBSOLETE bs x,
8624@c OBSOLETE CASE bs OF
8625@c OBSOLETE (karli):
8626@c OBSOLETE cs a
8627@c OBSOLETE (ott):
8628@c OBSOLETE ds x
8629@c OBSOLETE ESAC
8630@c OBSOLETE )
8631@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8632@c OBSOLETE @end table
8633@c OBSOLETE
8634@c OBSOLETE @node Locations
8635@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8636@c OBSOLETE
8637@c OBSOLETE A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8638@c OBSOLETE
8639@c OBSOLETE A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
8640@c OBSOLETE the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8641@c OBSOLETE Chill programs. How values are specified
8642@c OBSOLETE is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
8643@c OBSOLETE
8644@c OBSOLETE The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8645@c OBSOLETE display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
8646@c OBSOLETE
8647@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8648@c OBSOLETE set result := EXPR
8649@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8650@c OBSOLETE
8651@c OBSOLETE @noindent
8652@c OBSOLETE This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
8653@c OBSOLETE is not available in @value{GDBN}).
8654@c OBSOLETE
8655@c OBSOLETE Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8656@c OBSOLETE value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
8657@c OBSOLETE mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
8658@c OBSOLETE represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8659@c OBSOLETE value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
8660@c OBSOLETE operator @samp{->}.
8661@c OBSOLETE
8662@c OBSOLETE Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8663@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8664@c OBSOLETE @code{@{ PROC
8665@c OBSOLETE (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
8666@c OBSOLETE location>}
8667@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8668@c OBSOLETE @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8669@c OBSOLETE specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8670@c OBSOLETE the entry point.
8671@c OBSOLETE
8672@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8673@c OBSOLETE Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8674@c OBSOLETE fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8675@c OBSOLETE the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
8676@c OBSOLETE implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8677@c OBSOLETE na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8678@c OBSOLETE <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
8679@c OBSOLETE @code{__proc_copy}.
8680@c OBSOLETE
8681@c OBSOLETE Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8682@c OBSOLETE the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8683@c OBSOLETE like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8684@c OBSOLETE mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8685@c OBSOLETE
8686@c OBSOLETE Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
8687@c OBSOLETE ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
8688@c OBSOLETE definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
8689@c OBSOLETE of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8690@c OBSOLETE structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8691@c OBSOLETE braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
8692@c OBSOLETE on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
8693@c OBSOLETE memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
8694@c OBSOLETE all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
8695@c OBSOLETE @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
8696@c OBSOLETE stuff ???)
8697@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8698@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8699@c OBSOLETE [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8700@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8701@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8702@c OBSOLETE
8703@c OBSOLETE Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8704@c OBSOLETE (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
8705@c OBSOLETE certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8706@c OBSOLETE and their Operations}.
8707@c OBSOLETE
8708@c OBSOLETE A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
8709@c OBSOLETE location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8710@c OBSOLETE name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8711@c OBSOLETE have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8712@c OBSOLETE checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
8713@c OBSOLETE therefore the result can be quite confusing.
8714@c OBSOLETE
8715@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8716@c OBSOLETE (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8717@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8718@c OBSOLETE
8719@c OBSOLETE @node Values and their Operations
8720@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Values and their Operations
8721@c OBSOLETE
8722@c OBSOLETE Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8723@c OBSOLETE more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
8724@c OBSOLETE data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8725@c OBSOLETE such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
8726@c OBSOLETE constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
8727@c OBSOLETE when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
8728@c OBSOLETE (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8729@c OBSOLETE the values behind these locations.
8730@c OBSOLETE
8731@c OBSOLETE This section describes how values have to be specified and which
8732@c OBSOLETE operations are legal to be used with such values.
8733@c OBSOLETE
8734@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8735@c OBSOLETE @item Literal Values
8736@c OBSOLETE Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8737@c OBSOLETE For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
8738@c OBSOLETE chapter 1.5.
8739@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8740@c OBSOLETE @c be converted to a @ref.
8741@c OBSOLETE
8742@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8743@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8744@c OBSOLETE @item
8745@c OBSOLETE @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8746@c OBSOLETE programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
8747@c OBSOLETE @item
8748@c OBSOLETE @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8749@c OBSOLETE @item
8750@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8751@c OBSOLETE @code{'M'})
8752@c OBSOLETE @item
8753@c OBSOLETE @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
8754@c OBSOLETE mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
8755@c OBSOLETE comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
8756@c OBSOLETE @item
8757@c OBSOLETE @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
8758@c OBSOLETE emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
8759@c OBSOLETE procedure value or the empty instance value.
8760@c OBSOLETE
8761@c OBSOLETE @item
8762@c OBSOLETE @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
8763@c OBSOLETE enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
8764@c OBSOLETE to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
8765@c OBSOLETE @item
8766@c OBSOLETE @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8767@c OBSOLETE programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
8768@c OBSOLETE @item
8769@c OBSOLETE @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
8770@c OBSOLETE (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
8771@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8772@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8773@c OBSOLETE
8774@c OBSOLETE @item Tuple Values
8775@c OBSOLETE A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
8776@c OBSOLETE name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
8777@c OBSOLETE unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
8778@c OBSOLETE @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
8779@c OBSOLETE
8780@c OBSOLETE @itemize @bullet
8781@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
8782@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Array Tuple}
8783@c OBSOLETE @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
8784@c OBSOLETE Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
8785@c OBSOLETE same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
8786@c OBSOLETE @end itemize
8787@c OBSOLETE
8788@c OBSOLETE @item String Element Value
8789@c OBSOLETE A string element value is specified by
8790@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8791@c OBSOLETE @code{<string value>(<index>)}
8792@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8793@c OBSOLETE where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
8794@c OBSOLETE value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
8795@c OBSOLETE the string.
8796@c OBSOLETE
8797@c OBSOLETE @item String Slice Value
8798@c OBSOLETE A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
8799@c OBSOLETE spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
8800@c OBSOLETE expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
8801@c OBSOLETE @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
8802@c OBSOLETE The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
8803@c OBSOLETE string.
8804@c OBSOLETE
8805@c OBSOLETE @item Array Element Values
8806@c OBSOLETE An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
8807@c OBSOLETE delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
8808@c OBSOLETE
8809@c OBSOLETE @item Array Slice Values
8810@c OBSOLETE An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
8811@c OBSOLETE @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
8812@c OBSOLETE @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
8813@c OBSOLETE arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
8814@c OBSOLETE which is part of the specified array.
8815@c OBSOLETE
8816@c OBSOLETE @item Structure Field Values
8817@c OBSOLETE A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
8818@c OBSOLETE name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
8819@c OBSOLETE in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
8820@c OBSOLETE corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
8821@c OBSOLETE
8822@c OBSOLETE @item Procedure Call Value
8823@c OBSOLETE The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
8824@c OBSOLETE procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
8825@c OBSOLETE expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
8826@c OBSOLETE effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
8827@c OBSOLETE
8828@c OBSOLETE Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
8829@c OBSOLETE
8830@c OBSOLETE Values of time mode locations appear as
8831@c OBSOLETE @smallexample
8832@c OBSOLETE @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8833@c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
8834@c OBSOLETE
8835@c OBSOLETE
8836@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8837@c OBSOLETE This is not implemented yet:
8838@c OBSOLETE @item Built-in Value
8839@c OBSOLETE @noindent
8840@c OBSOLETE The following built in functions are provided:
8841@c OBSOLETE
8842@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8843@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ADDR()}
8844@c OBSOLETE @item @code{NUM()}
8845@c OBSOLETE @item @code{PRED()}
8846@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SUCC()}
8847@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ABS()}
8848@c OBSOLETE @item @code{CARD()}
8849@c OBSOLETE @item @code{MAX()}
8850@c OBSOLETE @item @code{MIN()}
8851@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIZE()}
8852@c OBSOLETE @item @code{UPPER()}
8853@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOWER()}
8854@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LENGTH()}
8855@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SIN()}
8856@c OBSOLETE @item @code{COS()}
8857@c OBSOLETE @item @code{TAN()}
8858@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCSIN()}
8859@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCCOS()}
8860@c OBSOLETE @item @code{ARCTAN()}
8861@c OBSOLETE @item @code{EXP()}
8862@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LN()}
8863@c OBSOLETE @item @code{LOG()}
8864@c OBSOLETE @item @code{SQRT()}
8865@c OBSOLETE @end table
8866@c OBSOLETE
8867@c OBSOLETE For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8868@c OBSOLETE chapter 1.6.
8869@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8870@c OBSOLETE
8871@c OBSOLETE @item Zero-adic Operator Value
8872@c OBSOLETE The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8873@c OBSOLETE current active process.
8874@c OBSOLETE
8875@c OBSOLETE @item Expression Values
8876@c OBSOLETE The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
8877@c OBSOLETE the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
8878@c OBSOLETE incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
8879@c OBSOLETE corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
8880@c OBSOLETE causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
8881@c OBSOLETE which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
8882@c OBSOLETE operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
8883@c OBSOLETE
8884@c OBSOLETE @table @code
8885@c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
8886@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8887@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
8888@c OBSOLETE Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
8889@c OBSOLETE
8890@c OBSOLETE @item @code{=, /=}
8891@c OBSOLETE Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
8892@c OBSOLETE
8893@c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
8894@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
8895@c OBSOLETE Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
8896@c OBSOLETE
8897@c OBSOLETE @item @code{+, -}
8898@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
8899@c OBSOLETE Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
8900@c OBSOLETE
8901@c OBSOLETE @item @code{-}
8902@c OBSOLETE Change sign operator.
8903@c OBSOLETE
8904@c OBSOLETE @item @code{//}
8905@c OBSOLETE String concatenation operator.
8906@c OBSOLETE
8907@c OBSOLETE @item @code{()}
8908@c OBSOLETE String repetition operator.
8909@c OBSOLETE
8910@c OBSOLETE @item @code{->}
8911@c OBSOLETE Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8912@c OBSOLETE address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8913@c OBSOLETE location (@code{loc->}).
8914@c OBSOLETE
8915@c OBSOLETE @item @code{OR, XOR}
8916@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{AND}
8917@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{NOT}
8918@c OBSOLETE Powerset and bitstring operators.
8919@c OBSOLETE
8920@c OBSOLETE @item @code{>, >=}
8921@c OBSOLETE @itemx @code{<, <=}
8922@c OBSOLETE Powerset inclusion operators.
8923@c OBSOLETE
8924@c OBSOLETE @item @code{IN}
8925@c OBSOLETE Membership operator.
8926@c OBSOLETE @end table
8927@c OBSOLETE @end table
8928@c OBSOLETE
8929@c OBSOLETE @node Chill type and range checks
8930@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8931@c OBSOLETE
8932@c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
8933@c OBSOLETE of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
8934@c OBSOLETE complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
8935@c OBSOLETE equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
8936@c OBSOLETE structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8937@c OBSOLETE
8938@c OBSOLETE Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8939@c OBSOLETE index bounds and all built in procedures.
8940@c OBSOLETE
8941@c OBSOLETE Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
8942@c OBSOLETE check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
8943@c OBSOLETE operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8944@c OBSOLETE functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8945@c OBSOLETE language specification.
8946@c OBSOLETE
8947@c OBSOLETE All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8948@c OBSOLETE off}.
8949@c OBSOLETE
8950@c OBSOLETE @ignore
8951@c OBSOLETE @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
8952@c OBSOLETE see last paragraph ?
8953@c OBSOLETE @end ignore
8954@c OBSOLETE
8955@c OBSOLETE @node Chill defaults
8956@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Chill defaults
8957@c OBSOLETE
8958@c OBSOLETE If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8959@c OBSOLETE both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8960@c OBSOLETE Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8961@c OBSOLETE selected the working language.
8962@c OBSOLETE
8963@c OBSOLETE If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8964@c OBSOLETE code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
8965@c OBSOLETE working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8966@c OBSOLETE the language automatically}, for further details.
cce74817 8967
6d2ebf8b 8968@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8969@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8970
d4f3574e 8971The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8972symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8973program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8974does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8975program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8976(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8977file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8978
8979@cindex symbol names
8980@cindex names of symbols
8981@cindex quoting names
8982Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8983characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8984most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8985source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8986are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8987ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8988@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8989@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8990
474c8240 8991@smallexample
c906108c 8992p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8993@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8994
8995@noindent
8996looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8997
8998@table @code
8999@kindex info address
b37052ae 9000@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
9001@item info address @var{symbol}
9002Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
9003variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
9004local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
9005is always stored.
9006
9007Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
9008at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
9009the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
9010
3d67e040 9011@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 9012@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
9013@item info symbol @var{addr}
9014Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
9015If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
9016nearest symbol and an offset from it:
9017
474c8240 9018@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
9019(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
9020_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 9021@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
9022
9023@noindent
9024This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
9025it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
9026
c906108c 9027@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
9028@item whatis @var{expr}
9029Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
9030actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
9031assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
9032@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9033
9034@item whatis
9035Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9036
9037@kindex ptype
9038@item ptype @var{typename}
9039Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
9040the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
9041@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
9042@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 9043
d4f3574e 9044@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 9045@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 9046Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
9047differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
9048of just the name of the type.
9049
9050For example, for this variable declaration:
9051
474c8240 9052@smallexample
c906108c 9053struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 9054@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9055
9056@noindent
9057the two commands give this output:
9058
474c8240 9059@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9060@group
9061(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
9062type = struct complex
9063(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
9064type = struct complex @{
9065 double real;
9066 double imag;
9067@}
9068@end group
474c8240 9069@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9070
9071@noindent
9072As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
9073the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
9074
9075@kindex info types
9076@item info types @var{regexp}
9077@itemx info types
d4f3574e 9078Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
9079(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9080complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9081@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 9082names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
9083information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9084
9085This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9086@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9087lists all source files where a type is defined.
9088
b37052ae
EZ
9089@kindex info scope
9090@cindex local variables
9091@item info scope @var{addr}
9092List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9093accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9094preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9095scope defined by that location. For example:
9096
9097@smallexample
9098(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9099Scope for command_line_handler:
9100Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9101Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9102Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9103Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9104Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9105Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9106Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9107@end smallexample
9108
f5c37c66
EZ
9109@noindent
9110This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9111during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9112collect}.
9113
c906108c
SS
9114@kindex info source
9115@item info source
919d772c
JB
9116Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9117the function containing the current point of execution:
9118@itemize @bullet
9119@item
9120the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9121@item
9122the directory it was compiled in,
9123@item
9124its length, in lines,
9125@item
9126which programming language it is written in,
9127@item
9128whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9129if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9130@item
9131whether the debugging information includes information about
9132preprocessor macros.
9133@end itemize
9134
c906108c
SS
9135
9136@kindex info sources
9137@item info sources
9138Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9139debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9140have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9141
9142@kindex info functions
9143@item info functions
9144Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9145
9146@item info functions @var{regexp}
9147Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9148whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9149Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9150include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
9151start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9152that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9153@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
9154
9155@kindex info variables
9156@item info variables
9157Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 9158outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
9159
9160@item info variables @var{regexp}
9161Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9162variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9163@var{regexp}.
9164
9165@ignore
9166This was never implemented.
9167@kindex info methods
9168@item info methods
9169@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9170The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
9171methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9172specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9173C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
9174from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9175@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9176which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9177@end ignore
9178
c906108c
SS
9179@cindex reloading symbols
9180Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
9181be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9182in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9183running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9184@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
9185
9186@table @code
9187@kindex set symbol-reloading
9188@item set symbol-reloading on
9189Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9190object file with a particular name is seen again.
9191
9192@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
9193Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9194same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9195running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9196should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9197may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9198several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9199name.
c906108c
SS
9200
9201@kindex show symbol-reloading
9202@item show symbol-reloading
9203Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9204@end table
c906108c 9205
c906108c
SS
9206@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9207@item set opaque-type-resolution on
9208Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9209declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9210@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9211source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9212another source file. The default is on.
9213
9214A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9215the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9216
9217@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9218Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9219is printed as follows:
9220@smallexample
9221@{<no data fields>@}
9222@end smallexample
9223
9224@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9225@item show opaque-type-resolution
9226Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9227
9228@kindex maint print symbols
9229@cindex symbol dump
9230@kindex maint print psymbols
9231@cindex partial symbol dump
9232@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9233@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9234@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9235Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9236These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9237symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9238symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9239collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9240only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9241command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9242use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9243symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9244files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9245@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9246required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9247@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9248@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9249@end table
9250
6d2ebf8b 9251@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9252@chapter Altering Execution
9253
9254Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9255find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9256correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9257experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9258program.
9259
9260For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9261locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9262address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9263
9264@menu
9265* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9266* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9267* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9268* Returning:: Returning from a function
9269* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9270* Patching:: Patching your program
9271@end menu
9272
6d2ebf8b 9273@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9274@section Assignment to variables
9275
9276@cindex assignment
9277@cindex setting variables
9278To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9279@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9280
474c8240 9281@smallexample
c906108c 9282print x=4
474c8240 9283@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9284
9285@noindent
9286stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9287value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9288@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9289information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9290
9291@kindex set variable
9292@cindex variables, setting
9293If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9294@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9295really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9296not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9297,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9298
c906108c
SS
9299If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9300appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9301variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9302to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9303program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9304a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9305command @code{set width}:
9306
474c8240 9307@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9308(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9309type = double
9310(@value{GDBP}) p width
9311$4 = 13
9312(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9313Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9314@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9315
9316@noindent
9317The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9318order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9319
474c8240 9320@smallexample
c906108c 9321(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9322@end smallexample
53a5351d 9323
c906108c
SS
9324Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9325with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9326@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9327your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9328to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9329the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9330
474c8240 9331@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9332@group
9333(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9334type = double
9335(@value{GDBP}) p g
9336$1 = 1
9337(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9338(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9339$2 = 1
9340(@value{GDBP}) r
9341The program being debugged has been started already.
9342Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9343Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9344"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9345 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9346(@value{GDBP}) show g
9347The current BFD target is "=4".
9348@end group
474c8240 9349@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9350
9351@noindent
9352The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9353@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9354@code{g}, use
9355
474c8240 9356@smallexample
c906108c 9357(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9358@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9359
9360@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9361freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9362and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9363same length or shorter.
9364@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9365@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9366
9367To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9368construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9369(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9370to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9371and representation in memory), and
9372
474c8240 9373@smallexample
c906108c 9374set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9375@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9376
9377@noindent
9378stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9379
6d2ebf8b 9380@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9381@section Continuing at a different address
9382
9383Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9384it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9385an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9386
9387@table @code
9388@kindex jump
9389@item jump @var{linespec}
9390Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9391immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9392source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9393@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9394in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9395breakpoints}.
9396
9397The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9398the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9399register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9400a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9401be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9402of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9403confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9404executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9405well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9406
9407@item jump *@var{address}
9408Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9409@end table
9410
c906108c 9411@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9412On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9413command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9414difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9415changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9416example,
c906108c 9417
474c8240 9418@smallexample
c906108c 9419set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9420@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9421
9422@noindent
9423makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9424address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9425@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9426
9427The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9428up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9429that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9430detail.
9431
c906108c 9432@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9433@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9434@section Giving your program a signal
9435
9436@table @code
9437@kindex signal
9438@item signal @var{signal}
9439Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9440signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9441signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9442SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9443
9444Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9445giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9446a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9447@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9448signal.
9449
9450@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9451after executing the command.
9452@end table
9453@c @end group
9454
9455Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9456@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9457causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9458the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9459passes the signal directly to your program.
9460
c906108c 9461
6d2ebf8b 9462@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9463@section Returning from a function
9464
9465@table @code
9466@cindex returning from a function
9467@kindex return
9468@item return
9469@itemx return @var{expression}
9470You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9471command. If you give an
9472@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9473value.
9474@end table
9475
9476When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9477(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9478discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9479be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9480
9481This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9482frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9483innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9484specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9485of functions.
9486
9487The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9488program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9489returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9490and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9491selected stack frame returns naturally.
9492
6d2ebf8b 9493@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9494@section Calling program functions
9495
9496@cindex calling functions
9497@kindex call
9498@table @code
9499@item call @var{expr}
9500Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9501returned values.
9502@end table
9503
9504You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9505execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9506with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9507is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9508
6d2ebf8b 9509@node Patching
c906108c 9510@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9511
c906108c
SS
9512@cindex patching binaries
9513@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9514@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9515
7a292a7a
SS
9516By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9517executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9518alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9519patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9520
9521If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9522explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9523want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9524repairs.
9525
9526@table @code
9527@kindex set write
9528@item set write on
9529@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9530If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9531core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9532off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9533
9534If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9535@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9536write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9537
9538@item show write
9539@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9540Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9541as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9542@end table
9543
6d2ebf8b 9544@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9545@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9546
7a292a7a
SS
9547@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9548both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9549program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9550@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9551
9552@menu
9553* Files:: Commands to specify files
9554* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9555@end menu
9556
6d2ebf8b 9557@node Files
c906108c 9558@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9559
7a292a7a 9560@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9561@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9562
9563You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9564way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9565@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9566Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9567
9568Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9569@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9570a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9571to specify new files are useful.
9572
9573@table @code
9574@cindex executable file
9575@kindex file
9576@item file @var{filename}
9577Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9578symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9579executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9580directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9581@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9582directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9583to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9584and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9585
6d2ebf8b 9586On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9587@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9588@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9589@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9590descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9591(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9592@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9593for more information.
c906108c
SS
9594
9595@item file
9596@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9597has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9598
9599@kindex exec-file
9600@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9601Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9602in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9603if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9604discard information on the executable file.
9605
9606@kindex symbol-file
9607@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9608Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9609searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9610table and program to run from the same file.
9611
9612@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9613program's symbol table.
9614
5d161b24 9615The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9616of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9617auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9618the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9619the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9620
9621@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9622executing it once.
9623
9624When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9625understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9626generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9627other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9628Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9629using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9630optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9631
9632For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9633using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9634symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9635quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9636details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9637
9638The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9639start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9640occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9641file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9642pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9643warnings and messages}.)
9644
c906108c
SS
9645We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9646symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9647symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9648still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9649in stabs format.
9650
9651@kindex readnow
9652@cindex reading symbols immediately
9653@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9654@kindex mapped
9655@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9656@cindex saving symbol table
9657@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9658@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9659You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9660tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9661load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9662entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9663
c906108c
SS
9664If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9665@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9666cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9667file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9668from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9669than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9670program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9671starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9672
9673You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9674file has all the symbol information for your program.
9675
9676The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9677@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9678than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9679it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9680needed.
9681
9682The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9683@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9684symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9685
9686@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9687@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9688@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9689@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9690@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9691@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9692@c files.
9693
9694@kindex core
9695@kindex core-file
9696@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9697Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9698of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9699address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9700executable file itself for other parts.
9701
9702@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9703to be used.
9704
9705Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9706under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9707wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9708the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9709(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9710
c906108c
SS
9711@kindex add-symbol-file
9712@cindex dynamic linking
9713@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9714@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9715@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9716The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9717information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9718when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9719into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9720address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9721this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9722of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9723section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9724@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9725
9726The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9727originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9728@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9729thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9730instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9731
17d9d558
JB
9732@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9733@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9734@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9735@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9736@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9737Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9738executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9739relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9740information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9741
9742@itemize @bullet
9743@item
9744the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9745that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9746@item
9747every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9748been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9749@item
9750you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9751provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9752@end itemize
9753
9754@noindent
9755Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9756relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9757typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9758important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9759procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9760assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9761general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9762relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9763as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9764way.
9765
c906108c
SS
9766@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9767
9768You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9769the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9770table information for @var{filename}.
9771
9772@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9773@item add-shared-symbol-file
9774The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9775operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9776shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9777@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9778
c906108c
SS
9779@kindex section
9780@item section
5d161b24
DB
9781The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9782the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9783section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9784specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9785separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9786the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9787
9788@kindex info files
9789@kindex info target
9790@item info files
9791@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9792@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9793current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9794including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9795use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9796command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9797current ones.
9798
fe95c787
MS
9799@kindex maint info sections
9800@item maint info sections
9801Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9802is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9803displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9804offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9805@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9806may be arbitrarily combined):
9807
9808@table @code
9809@item ALLOBJ
9810Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9811@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9812Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9813@item @var{section-flags}
9814Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9815The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9816@table @code
9817@item ALLOC
9818Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9819Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9820@item LOAD
9821Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9822Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9823@item RELOC
9824Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9825@item READONLY
9826Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9827@item CODE
9828Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9829@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9830Section contains data only (no executable code).
9831@item ROM
9832Section will reside in ROM.
9833@item CONSTRUCTOR
9834Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9835@item HAS_CONTENTS
9836Section is not empty.
9837@item NEVER_LOAD
9838An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9839@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9840A notification to the linker that the section contains
9841COFF shared library information.
9842@item IS_COMMON
9843Section contains common symbols.
9844@end table
9845@end table
6763aef9
MS
9846@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9847@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9848Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9849really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9850In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9851out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9852For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9853enhancement to debugging performance.
9854
9855The default is off.
9856
9857@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9858Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9859the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9860and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9861@end table
9862
9863All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9864as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9865name and remembers it that way.
9866
c906108c 9867@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9868@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9869libraries.
53a5351d 9870
c906108c
SS
9871@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9872when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9873(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9874references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9875debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9876
9877On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9878automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9879
c906108c
SS
9880@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9881@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9882@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9883
b7209cb4
FF
9884There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9885symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9886particularly large or there are many of them.
9887
9888To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9889commands:
9890
9891@table @code
9892@kindex set auto-solib-add
9893@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9894If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9895will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9896attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9897informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9898is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9899@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9900
9901@kindex show auto-solib-add
9902@item show auto-solib-add
9903Display the current autoloading mode.
9904@end table
9905
9906To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9907command:
9908
c906108c
SS
9909@table @code
9910@kindex info sharedlibrary
9911@kindex info share
9912@item info share
9913@itemx info sharedlibrary
9914Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9915
9916@kindex sharedlibrary
9917@kindex share
9918@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9919@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9920Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9921Unix regular expression.
9922As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9923required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9924@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9925loaded.
9926@end table
9927
b7209cb4
FF
9928On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9929autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9930reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9931by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9932up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9933wish.
c906108c
SS
9934
9935Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9936loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9937@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9938automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9939
9940To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9941
9942@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9943@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9944@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9945Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9946If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9947symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9948size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9949Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9950@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9951Mb).
c906108c 9952
b7209cb4
FF
9953@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9954@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9955Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9956@end table
c906108c 9957
6d2ebf8b 9958@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9959@section Errors reading symbol files
9960
9961While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9962such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9963output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9964they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9965debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9966about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9967only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9968times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9969to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9970complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9971messages}).
9972
9973The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9974
9975@table @code
9976@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9977
9978The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9979(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9980error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9981in its outer scope blocks.
9982
9983@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9984the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9985may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9986function.
9987
9988@item block at @var{address} out of order
9989
9990The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9991order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9992do so.
9993
9994@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9995locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9996can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9997@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9998messages}.)
9999
10000@item bad block start address patched
10001
10002The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10003smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10004to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10005
10006@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10007starting on the previous source line.
10008
10009@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10010
10011@cindex foo
10012Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10013larger than the size of the string table.
10014
10015@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10016name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10017with this name.
10018
10019@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10020
7a292a7a
SS
10021The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10022not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 10023uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 10024
7a292a7a
SS
10025@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10026This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 10027are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
10028debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10029on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10030and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
10031
10032@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 10033
7a292a7a 10034@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 10035
7a292a7a 10036@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 10037The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
10038information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10039it.
c906108c
SS
10040
10041@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10042
10043@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 10044
c906108c
SS
10045@end table
10046
6d2ebf8b 10047@node Targets
c906108c 10048@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 10049
c906108c
SS
10050@cindex debugging target
10051@kindex target
10052
10053A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
10054
10055Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10056in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10057you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
10058flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10059host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
10060realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10061command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10062(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
10063
10064@menu
10065* Active Targets:: Active targets
10066* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
10067* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10068* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 10069* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
10070
10071@end menu
10072
6d2ebf8b 10073@node Active Targets
c906108c 10074@section Active targets
7a292a7a 10075
c906108c
SS
10076@cindex stacking targets
10077@cindex active targets
10078@cindex multiple targets
10079
c906108c 10080There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
10081executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10082active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10083start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10084a core file.
c906108c
SS
10085
10086For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10087@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10088well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10089@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10090first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10091requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10092are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10093read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10094executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10095
10096When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10097target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10098commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10099an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10100process target is active.
c906108c 10101
7a292a7a
SS
10102Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10103core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10104files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10105the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10106process}).
c906108c 10107
6d2ebf8b 10108@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10109@section Commands for managing targets
10110
10111@table @code
10112@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10113Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10114process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10115facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10116protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10117
10118Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10119typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10120with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10121
10122The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10123after executing the command.
10124
10125@kindex help target
10126@item help target
10127Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10128currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10129(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10130
10131@item help target @var{name}
10132Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10133select it.
10134
10135@kindex set gnutarget
10136@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10137@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10138knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10139a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10140with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10141with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10142
d4f3574e 10143@quotation
c906108c
SS
10144@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10145you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10146@end quotation
c906108c 10147
d4f3574e
SS
10148@noindent
10149@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10150
5d161b24 10151@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10152@item show gnutarget
10153Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10154@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10155@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10156and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10157@end table
10158
c906108c
SS
10159Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10160configuration):
c906108c
SS
10161
10162@table @code
10163@kindex target exec
10164@item target exec @var{program}
10165An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10166@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10167
c906108c
SS
10168@kindex target core
10169@item target core @var{filename}
10170A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10171@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10172
10173@kindex target remote
10174@item target remote @var{dev}
10175Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10176specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10177@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10178supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10179some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10180it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10181
c906108c
SS
10182@kindex target sim
10183@item target sim
2df3850c 10184Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10185In general,
474c8240 10186@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10187 target sim
10188 load
10189 run
474c8240 10190@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10191@noindent
104c1213 10192works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10193drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10194provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10195see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10196Processors}.
10197
c906108c
SS
10198@end table
10199
104c1213 10200Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10201
10202@table @code
10203
c906108c
SS
10204@kindex target nrom
10205@item target nrom @var{dev}
10206NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10207
c906108c
SS
10208@end table
10209
5d161b24 10210Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10211your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10212
10213Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10214once you've successfully established a connection.
10215
10216@table @code
10217
10218@kindex load @var{filename}
10219@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10220Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10221@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10222is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10223on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10224@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10225the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10226
10227If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10228execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10229target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10230
10231The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10232For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10233link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10234specifies a fixed address.
10235@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10236
c906108c
SS
10237@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10238@end table
10239
6d2ebf8b 10240@node Byte Order
c906108c 10241@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10242
c906108c
SS
10243@cindex choosing target byte order
10244@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10245
10246Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10247offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10248orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10249designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10250which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10251@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10252
10253@table @code
10254@kindex set endian big
10255@item set endian big
10256Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10257
10258@kindex set endian little
10259@item set endian little
10260Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10261
10262@kindex set endian auto
10263@item set endian auto
10264Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10265executable.
10266
10267@item show endian
10268Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10269
10270@end table
10271
10272Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10273data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10274target system.
10275
6d2ebf8b 10276@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10277@section Remote debugging
10278@cindex remote debugging
10279
10280If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10281@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10282For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10283or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10284powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10285
10286Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10287to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10288@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10289but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10290write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10291communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10292
10293Other remote targets may be available in your
10294configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10295
6f05cf9f
AC
10296@node KOD
10297@section Kernel Object Display
10298
10299@cindex kernel object display
10300@cindex kernel object
10301@cindex KOD
10302
10303Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10304@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10305and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10306mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10307displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10308
10309Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10310@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10311
474c8240 10312@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10313(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10314@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10315
10316If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10317about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10318which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10319after the operating system:
c906108c 10320
474c8240 10321@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10322(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10323List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10324Object Description
10325any Any and all objects
474c8240 10326@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10327
10328Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10329by the kernel.
10330
10331There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10332is supported other than to try it.
10333
10334
10335@node Remote Debugging
10336@chapter Debugging remote programs
10337
6b2f586d
AC
10338@menu
10339* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10340* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10341* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10342@end menu
10343
6f05cf9f
AC
10344@node Server
10345@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10346
10347@kindex gdbserver
10348@cindex remote connection without stubs
10349@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10350allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10351@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10352
10353@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10354because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10355that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10356@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10357@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10358because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10359also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10360started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10361Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10362the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10363do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10364by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10365choice for debugging.
10366
10367@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10368or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10369protocol.
10370
10371@table @emph
10372@item On the target machine,
10373you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10374@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10375strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10376system does all the symbol handling.
10377
10378To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10379the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10380syntax is:
10381
10382@smallexample
10383target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10384@end smallexample
10385
10386@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10387hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10388@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10389@file{/dev/com1}:
10390
10391@smallexample
10392target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10393@end smallexample
10394
10395@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10396with it.
10397
10398To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10399
10400@smallexample
10401target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10402@end smallexample
10403
10404The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10405specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10406TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10407expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10408(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10409you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10410TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10411reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10412conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10413and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10414@code{target remote} command.
10415
56460a61
DJ
10416On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10417This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10418
10419@smallexample
10420target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10421@end smallexample
10422
10423@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10424to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10425
6f05cf9f
AC
10426@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10427you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10428symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10429using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10430(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10431running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10432remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10433is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10434@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10435@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10436
10437@smallexample
10438(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10439@end smallexample
10440
10441@noindent
10442communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10443
10444@smallexample
10445(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10446@end smallexample
10447
10448@noindent
10449communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10450For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10451the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10452text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10453@samp{Connection refused}.
10454@end table
10455
10456@node NetWare
10457@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10458
10459@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10460@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10461allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10462@code{target remote}.
10463
10464@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10465using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10466
10467@table @emph
10468@item On the target machine,
10469you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10470@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10471can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10472host system does all the symbol handling.
10473
10474To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10475@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10476program. The syntax is:
10477
10478@smallexample
10479load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10480 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10481@end smallexample
10482
10483@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10484the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10485to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10486
10487For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10488communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10489using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10490
10491@smallexample
10492load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10493@end smallexample
10494
10495@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10496you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10497symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10498using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10499(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10500running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10501remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10502argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10503@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10504
10505@smallexample
10506(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10507@end smallexample
10508
10509@noindent
10510communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10511@end table
10512
10513@node remote stub
10514@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10515
8e04817f
AC
10516@cindex debugging stub, example
10517@cindex remote stub, example
10518@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10519The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10520communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10521@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10522these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10523implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10524with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10525organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10526
104c1213
JM
10527@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10528To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10529@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10530prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10531program, you need:
c906108c 10532
104c1213
JM
10533@enumerate
10534@item
10535A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10536have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10537your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10538
5d161b24 10539@item
d4f3574e 10540A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10541subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10542
104c1213
JM
10543@item
10544A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10545download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10546manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10547documentation.
10548@end enumerate
96baa820 10549
104c1213
JM
10550The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10551communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10552machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10553
104c1213
JM
10554@table @emph
10555@item On the host,
10556@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10557else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10558(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10559
10560@item On the target,
10561you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10562implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10563subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10564
10565On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10566@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10567@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10568@end table
96baa820 10569
104c1213
JM
10570The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10571machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10572@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10573
104c1213
JM
10574@cindex remote serial stub list
10575These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10576
104c1213
JM
10577@table @code
10578
10579@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10580@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10581@cindex Intel
10582@cindex i386
10583For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10584
10585@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10586@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10587@cindex Motorola 680x0
10588@cindex m680x0
10589For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10590
10591@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10592@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10593@cindex Hitachi
10594@cindex SH
10595For Hitachi SH architectures.
10596
10597@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10598@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10599@cindex Sparc
10600For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10601
10602@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10603@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10604@cindex Fujitsu
10605@cindex SparcLite
10606For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10607
10608@end table
10609
10610The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10611recently added stubs.
10612
10613@menu
10614* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10615* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10616* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10617@end menu
10618
6d2ebf8b 10619@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10620@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10621
10622@cindex remote serial stub
10623The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10624subroutines:
10625
10626@table @code
10627@item set_debug_traps
10628@kindex set_debug_traps
10629@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10630This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10631program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10632beginning of your program.
10633
10634@item handle_exception
10635@kindex handle_exception
10636@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10637This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10638explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10639run when a trap is triggered.
10640
10641@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10642execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10643with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10644protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10645representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10646information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10647retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10648execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10649@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10650machine.
104c1213
JM
10651
10652@item breakpoint
10653@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10654Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10655breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10656way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10657machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10658pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10659@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10660simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10661again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10662your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10663@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10664
10665Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10666to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10667start of your debugging session.
10668@end table
10669
6d2ebf8b 10670@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10671@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10672
10673@cindex remote stub, support routines
10674The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10675chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10676debugging target machine.
10677
10678First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10679serial port.
10680
10681@table @code
10682@item int getDebugChar()
10683@kindex getDebugChar
10684Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10685It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10686different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10687
10688@item void putDebugChar(int)
10689@kindex putDebugChar
10690Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10691It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10692different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10693@end table
10694
10695@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10696@cindex interrupting remote targets
10697If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10698running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10699for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10700character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10701remote system to stop.
10702
10703Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10704probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10705is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10706@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10707
10708Other routines you need to supply are:
10709
10710@table @code
10711@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10712@kindex exceptionHandler
10713Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10714handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10715way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10716are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10717containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10718@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10719its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10720might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10721exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10722@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10723and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10724you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10725should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10726
10727For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10728gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10729should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10730@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10731help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10732
10733@item void flush_i_cache()
10734@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10735On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10736instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10737instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10738
10739On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10740function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10741@end table
10742
10743@noindent
10744You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10745
10746@table @code
10747@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10748@kindex memset
10749This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10750memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10751@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10752either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10753@end table
10754
10755If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10756library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10757but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10758subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10759
10760
6d2ebf8b 10761@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10762@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10763
10764@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10765In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10766steps.
10767
10768@enumerate
10769@item
6d2ebf8b 10770Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10771(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10772@display
10773@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10774@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10775@end display
10776
10777@item
10778Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10779
474c8240 10780@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10781set_debug_traps();
10782breakpoint();
474c8240 10783@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10784
10785@item
10786For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10787@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10788
474c8240 10789@smallexample
104c1213 10790void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10791@end smallexample
104c1213 10792
d4f3574e 10793@noindent
104c1213 10794but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10795function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10796@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10797error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10798one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10799
10800@item
10801Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10802your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10803
10804@item
10805Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10806the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10807
10808@item
10809@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10810@c document that. FIXME.
10811Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10812whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10813
10814@item
10815To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10816as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10817This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10818of its pure text.
10819
d4f3574e 10820@item
104c1213 10821@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10822Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10823Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10824machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10825TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10826to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10827device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10828
474c8240 10829@smallexample
104c1213 10830target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10831@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10832
10833@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10834To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10835@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10836For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10837terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10838
474c8240 10839@smallexample
104c1213 10840target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10841@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10842
10843If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10844your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10845the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10846to port 1234 on your local machine:
10847
474c8240 10848@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10849target remote :1234
474c8240 10850@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10851@noindent
10852
10853Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10854
10855@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10856To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10857@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10858on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10859
10860@smallexample
10861target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10862@end smallexample
10863
10864When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10865that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10866busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10867session.
10868
104c1213
JM
10869@end enumerate
10870
10871Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10872step and continue the remote program.
10873
10874To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10875command.
10876
10877@cindex interrupting remote programs
10878@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10879Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10880interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10881program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10882and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10883interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10884
474c8240 10885@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10886Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10887Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10888@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10889
10890If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10891(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10892remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10893goes back to waiting.
10894
104c1213 10895
8e04817f
AC
10896@node Configurations
10897@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10898
8e04817f
AC
10899While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10900cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10901describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10902
8e04817f
AC
10903There are three major categories of configurations: native
10904configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10905operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10906different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10907are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10908
8e04817f
AC
10909@menu
10910* Native::
10911* Embedded OS::
10912* Embedded Processors::
10913* Architectures::
10914@end menu
104c1213 10915
8e04817f
AC
10916@node Native
10917@section Native
104c1213 10918
8e04817f
AC
10919This section describes details specific to particular native
10920configurations.
6cf7e474 10921
8e04817f
AC
10922@menu
10923* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10924* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10925* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10926* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10927@end menu
6cf7e474 10928
8e04817f
AC
10929@node HP-UX
10930@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10931
8e04817f
AC
10932On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10933begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10934name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10935
8e04817f
AC
10936@node SVR4 Process Information
10937@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10938
8e04817f
AC
10939@kindex /proc
10940@cindex process image
104c1213 10941
8e04817f
AC
10942Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10943used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10944subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10945this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10946several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10947@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10948@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10949and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
104c1213 10950
8e04817f
AC
10951@table @code
10952@kindex info proc
10953@item info proc
10954Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10955
8e04817f
AC
10956@kindex info proc mappings
10957@item info proc mappings
10958Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10959on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10960@ignore
10961@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10962@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10963@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10964@kindex info proc times
10965@item info proc times
10966Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10967its children.
6cf7e474 10968
8e04817f
AC
10969@kindex info proc id
10970@item info proc id
10971Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10972the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10973
8e04817f
AC
10974@kindex info proc status
10975@item info proc status
10976General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10977stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10978received.
d4f3574e 10979
8e04817f
AC
10980@item info proc all
10981Show all the above information about the process.
10982@end ignore
10983@end table
104c1213 10984
8e04817f
AC
10985@node DJGPP Native
10986@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10987@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10988@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10989@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10990
8e04817f
AC
10991@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10992MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10993that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10994top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10995
8e04817f
AC
10996@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10997defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10998subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10999
8e04817f
AC
11000@table @code
11001@kindex info dos
11002@item info dos
11003This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11004information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 11005
8e04817f
AC
11006@kindex sysinfo
11007@cindex MS-DOS system info
11008@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11009@item info dos sysinfo
11010This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11011platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11012DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 11013
8e04817f
AC
11014@cindex GDT
11015@cindex LDT
11016@cindex IDT
11017@cindex segment descriptor tables
11018@cindex descriptor tables display
11019@item info dos gdt
11020@itemx info dos ldt
11021@itemx info dos idt
11022These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11023and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11024tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11025that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11026descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11027descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11028rights.
104c1213 11029
8e04817f
AC
11030A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11031segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11032allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11033conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11034additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 11035
8e04817f
AC
11036@cindex garbled pointers
11037These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11038Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11039displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11040display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11041example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11042debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 11043
8e04817f
AC
11044@smallexample
11045@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11046@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11047@end smallexample
104c1213 11048
8e04817f
AC
11049@noindent
11050This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11051the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 11052
8e04817f
AC
11053@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11054@item info dos pde
11055@itemx info dos pte
11056These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11057Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11058data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11059into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11060page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11061may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11062Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11063that is currently in use.
104c1213 11064
8e04817f
AC
11065Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11066Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11067the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11068@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11069Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11070means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11071the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 11072
8e04817f
AC
11073@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11074These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11075Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11076controller.
104c1213 11077
8e04817f 11078These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 11079
8e04817f
AC
11080@cindex physical address from linear address
11081@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11082This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11083address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11084appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11085accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11086example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11087the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11088
8e04817f
AC
11089@smallexample
11090@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11091@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11092@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11093@end smallexample
104c1213 11094
8e04817f
AC
11095@noindent
11096This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11097whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11098attributes of that page.
104c1213 11099
8e04817f
AC
11100Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11101since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11102address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11103be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11104declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11105@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11106
8e04817f
AC
11107Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11108transfer buffer:
104c1213 11109
8e04817f
AC
11110@smallexample
11111@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11112@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11113@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11114@end smallexample
104c1213 11115
8e04817f
AC
11116@noindent
11117(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
111183rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11119this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11120mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11121
8e04817f
AC
11122This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11123@end table
104c1213 11124
78c47bea
PM
11125@node Cygwin Native
11126@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11127@cindex MS Windows debugging
11128@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11129@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11130
11131@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
11132defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
11133subsection describes those commands.
11134
11135@table @code
11136@kindex info w32
11137@item info w32
11138This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11139information about the target system and important OS structures.
11140
11141@item info w32 selector
11142This command displays information returned by
11143the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11144It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11145a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11146Without argument, this command displays information
11147about the the six segment registers.
11148
11149@kindex info dll
11150@item info dll
11151This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11152
11153@kindex dll-symbols
11154@item dll-symbols
11155This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11156add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11157
11158@kindex set new-console
11159@item set new-console @var{mode}
11160If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11161be started in a new console on next start.
11162If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11163be started in the same console as the debugger.
11164
11165@kindex show new-console
11166@item show new-console
11167Displays whether a new console is used
11168when the debuggee is started.
11169
11170@kindex set new-group
11171@item set new-group @var{mode}
11172This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11173start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11174This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11175Ctrl-C.
11176
11177@kindex show new-group
11178@item show new-group
11179Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11180
11181@kindex set debugevents
11182@item set debugevents
11183This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11184
11185@kindex set debugexec
11186@item set debugexec
11187This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11188seen by the debugger.
11189
11190@kindex set debugexceptions
11191@item set debugexceptions
11192This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11193seen by the debugger.
11194
11195@kindex set debugmemory
11196@item set debugmemory
11197This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11198seen by the debugger.
11199
11200@kindex set shell
11201@item set shell
11202This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11203via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11204
11205@kindex show shell
11206@item show shell
11207Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11208
11209@end table
11210
8e04817f
AC
11211@node Embedded OS
11212@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11213
8e04817f
AC
11214This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11215embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11216architectures.
d4f3574e 11217
8e04817f
AC
11218@menu
11219* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11220@end menu
104c1213 11221
8e04817f
AC
11222@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11223various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11224
8e04817f
AC
11225@node VxWorks
11226@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11227
8e04817f 11228@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11229
8e04817f 11230@table @code
104c1213 11231
8e04817f
AC
11232@kindex target vxworks
11233@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11234A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11235is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11236
8e04817f 11237@end table
104c1213 11238
8e04817f
AC
11239On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11240current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11241
8e04817f
AC
11242@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11243VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11244the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11245both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11246@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11247installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11248@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11249
8e04817f
AC
11250@table @code
11251@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11252@kindex vxworks-timeout
11253All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11254This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11255seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11256your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11257of a thin network line.
11258@end table
104c1213 11259
8e04817f
AC
11260The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11261this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11262procedures.
104c1213 11263
8e04817f
AC
11264@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11265To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11266to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11267library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11268VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11269kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11270source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11271information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11272manual.
11273@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11274
8e04817f
AC
11275Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11276your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11277run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11278@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11279
8e04817f 11280@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11281
474c8240 11282@smallexample
8e04817f 11283(vxgdb)
474c8240 11284@end smallexample
104c1213 11285
8e04817f
AC
11286@menu
11287* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11288* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11289* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11290@end menu
104c1213 11291
8e04817f
AC
11292@node VxWorks Connection
11293@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11294
8e04817f
AC
11295The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11296network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11297
474c8240 11298@smallexample
8e04817f 11299(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11300@end smallexample
104c1213 11301
8e04817f
AC
11302@need 750
11303@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11304
8e04817f
AC
11305@smallexample
11306Attaching remote machine across net...
11307Connected to tt.
11308@end smallexample
104c1213 11309
8e04817f
AC
11310@need 1000
11311@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11312loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11313these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11314path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11315to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11316
474c8240 11317@smallexample
8e04817f 11318prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11319@end smallexample
104c1213 11320
8e04817f
AC
11321When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11322the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11323command again.
104c1213 11324
8e04817f
AC
11325@node VxWorks Download
11326@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11327
8e04817f
AC
11328@cindex download to VxWorks
11329If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11330object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11331@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11332incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11333command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11334to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11335table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11336the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11337filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11338Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11339to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11340the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11341@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11342and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11343program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11344
474c8240 11345@smallexample
8e04817f 11346-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11347@end smallexample
104c1213 11348
8e04817f
AC
11349@noindent
11350Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11351
474c8240 11352@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11353(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11354(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11355@end smallexample
104c1213 11356
8e04817f 11357@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11358
8e04817f
AC
11359@smallexample
11360Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11361@end smallexample
104c1213 11362
8e04817f
AC
11363You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11364after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11365this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11366auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11367history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11368debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11369table.)
104c1213 11370
8e04817f
AC
11371@node VxWorks Attach
11372@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11373
11374@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11375You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11376follows:
11377
474c8240 11378@smallexample
104c1213 11379(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11380@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11381
11382@noindent
11383where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11384or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11385the time of attachment.
11386
6d2ebf8b 11387@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11388@section Embedded Processors
11389
11390This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11391configurations.
11392
7d86b5d5 11393
104c1213 11394@menu
104c1213
JM
11395* ARM:: ARM
11396* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11397* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11398* i960:: Intel i960
11399* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11400* M68K:: Motorola M68K
7fb623f7 11401@c OBSOLETE * M88K:: Motorola M88K
104c1213
JM
11402* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11403* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11404* PowerPC: PowerPC
11405* SH:: Hitachi SH
11406* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11407* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11408* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11409* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11410@end menu
11411
6d2ebf8b 11412@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11413@subsection ARM
11414
11415@table @code
11416
8e04817f
AC
11417@kindex target rdi
11418@item target rdi @var{dev}
11419ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11420use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11421monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11422
11423@kindex target rdp
11424@item target rdp @var{dev}
11425ARM Demon monitor.
11426
11427@end table
11428
11429@node H8/300
11430@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11431
11432@table @code
11433
11434@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11435@item target hms @var{dev}
11436A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11437Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11438line and the communications speed used.
11439
11440@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11441@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11442E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11443
11444@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11445@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11446@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11447@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11448Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11449
11450@end table
11451
11452@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11453@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11454@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11455@cindex Hitachi SH download
11456When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11457board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11458board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11459@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11460
11461@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11462Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11463
11464@enumerate
11465@item
11466that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11467for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11468emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11469the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11470H8/300, or H8/500.)
11471
11472@item
11473what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11474serial device available on your host is the default).
11475
11476@item
11477what speed to use over the serial device.
11478@end enumerate
11479
11480@menu
11481* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11482* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11483* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11484@end menu
11485
11486@node Hitachi Boards
11487@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11488
11489@c only for Unix hosts
11490@kindex device
11491@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11492Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11493need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11494first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11495hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11496
11497@kindex speed
11498@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11499@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11500speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11501hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11502the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11503@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11504
11505The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11506use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11507use a DOS host,
11508@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11509called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11510through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11511to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11512
11513The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11514program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11515sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11516the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11517
11518First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11519board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11520port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11521When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11522debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11523for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11524@code{COM2}.
11525
474c8240 11526@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11527C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11528C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11529
11530Resident portion of MODE loaded
11531
11532COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11533
474c8240 11534@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11535
11536@quotation
11537@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11538@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11539disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11540your development board.
11541@end quotation
11542
11543@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11544Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11545connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11546the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11547you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11548commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11549cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11550download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11551the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11552(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11553executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11554@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11555itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11556
11557@smallexample
11558(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11559@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11560 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11561 the conditions.
11562There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11563for details.
11564@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11565(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11566Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11567(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11568.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11569.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11570.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11571@end smallexample
11572
11573At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11574you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11575sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11576@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11577resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11578@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11579
11580Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11581available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11582you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11583
11584Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11585@itemize @bullet
11586@item
11587to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11588no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11589
11590@item
11591to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11592normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11593to detect program completion.
11594@end itemize
11595
11596In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11597development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11598
11599@node Hitachi ICE
11600@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11601
11602@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11603You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11604Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11605e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11606
11607@table @code
11608@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11609Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11610@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11611@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11612(for example, @samp{9600}).
11613
11614@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11615If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11616specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11617@end table
11618
11619@node Hitachi Special
11620@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11621
11622Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11623
11624@table @code
11625
11626@kindex set machine
11627@kindex show machine
11628@item set machine h8300
11629@itemx set machine h8300h
11630Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11631architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11632to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11633
11634@end table
11635
8e04817f
AC
11636@node H8/500
11637@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11638
11639@table @code
11640
8e04817f
AC
11641@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11642@cindex memory models, H8/500
11643@item set memory @var{mod}
11644@itemx show memory
11645Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11646@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11647memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11648@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11649
8e04817f 11650@end table
104c1213 11651
8e04817f
AC
11652@node i960
11653@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11654
8e04817f 11655@table @code
104c1213 11656
8e04817f
AC
11657@kindex target mon960
11658@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11659MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11660
8e04817f
AC
11661@kindex target nindy
11662@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11663An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11664the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11665@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11666
8e04817f
AC
11667@end table
11668
11669@cindex Nindy
11670@cindex i960
11671@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11672@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11673tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11674
11675@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11676@item
8e04817f
AC
11677Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11678Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11679
11680@item
8e04817f 11681By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11682
11683@item
8e04817f
AC
11684By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11685session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11686
11687@end itemize
11688
11689@cindex download to Nindy-960
11690With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11691downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11692@value{GDBN}.
11693
11694@menu
11695* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11696* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11697* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11698@end menu
11699
11700@node Nindy Startup
11701@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11702
11703If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11704options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11705reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11706
474c8240 11707@smallexample
8e04817f 11708Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
474c8240 11709@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11710
11711@noindent
11712Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11713identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11714simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11715with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11716use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11717
11718@node Nindy Options
11719@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11720
11721These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11722Nindy-960 board attached:
11723
11724@table @code
11725@item -r @var{port}
11726Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11727to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11728configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11729@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11730device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11731suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11732
11733@item -O
11734(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11735the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11736This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11737target architecture.
11738
11739@quotation
11740@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11741connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11742fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11743attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11744this process with an interrupt.
11745@end quotation
11746
11747@item -brk
11748Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11749system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11750
11751@quotation
11752@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11753requires; it only works with a few boards.
11754@end quotation
11755@end table
11756
11757The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11758port.
11759
11760@c @group
11761@node Nindy Reset
11762@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11763
11764@table @code
11765@item reset
11766@kindex reset
11767For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11768system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11769circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11770a break is detected.
11771@end table
11772@c @end group
11773
11774@node M32R/D
11775@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11776
11777@table @code
11778
11779@kindex target m32r
11780@item target m32r @var{dev}
11781Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11782
11783@end table
11784
11785@node M68K
11786@subsection M68k
11787
11788The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11789target command for the following ROM monitors.
11790
11791@table @code
11792
11793@kindex target abug
11794@item target abug @var{dev}
11795ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11796
11797@kindex target cpu32bug
11798@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11799CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11800
11801@kindex target dbug
11802@item target dbug @var{dev}
11803dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11804
11805@kindex target est
11806@item target est @var{dev}
11807EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11808
11809@kindex target rom68k
11810@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11811ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11812
11813@end table
11814
11815If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11816instead have only a single special target command:
11817
11818@table @code
11819
11820@kindex target es1800
11821@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11822ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11823
11824@end table
11825
11826[context?]
11827
11828@table @code
11829
11830@kindex target rombug
11831@item target rombug @var{dev}
11832ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11833
11834@end table
11835
7fb623f7
AC
11836@c OBSOLETE @node M88K
11837@c OBSOLETE @subsection M88K
11838@c OBSOLETE
11839@c OBSOLETE @table @code
11840@c OBSOLETE
11841@c OBSOLETE @kindex target bug
11842@c OBSOLETE @item target bug @var{dev}
11843@c OBSOLETE BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11844@c OBSOLETE
11845@c OBSOLETE @end table
8e04817f
AC
11846
11847@node MIPS Embedded
11848@subsection MIPS Embedded
11849
11850@cindex MIPS boards
11851@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11852MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11853you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11854
8e04817f
AC
11855@need 1000
11856Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11857
8e04817f
AC
11858@table @code
11859@item target mips @var{port}
11860@kindex target mips @var{port}
11861To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11862name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11863command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11864the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11865been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11866download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11867
8e04817f
AC
11868For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11869port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11870debugger:
104c1213 11871
474c8240 11872@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11873host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11874@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11875(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11876(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11877(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11878@end smallexample
104c1213 11879
8e04817f
AC
11880@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11881On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11882connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11883concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11884@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11885
8e04817f
AC
11886@item target pmon @var{port}
11887@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11888PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11889
8e04817f
AC
11890@item target ddb @var{port}
11891@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11892NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11893
8e04817f
AC
11894@item target lsi @var{port}
11895@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11896LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11897
8e04817f
AC
11898@kindex target r3900
11899@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11900Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11901
8e04817f
AC
11902@kindex target array
11903@item target array @var{dev}
11904Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11905
8e04817f 11906@end table
104c1213 11907
104c1213 11908
8e04817f
AC
11909@noindent
11910@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11911
8e04817f
AC
11912@table @code
11913@item set processor @var{args}
11914@itemx show processor
11915@kindex set processor @var{args}
11916@kindex show processor
11917Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11918processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11919For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11920to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11921Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11922is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11923@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11924
8e04817f
AC
11925@item set mipsfpu double
11926@itemx set mipsfpu single
11927@itemx set mipsfpu none
11928@itemx show mipsfpu
11929@kindex set mipsfpu
11930@kindex show mipsfpu
11931@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11932@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11933If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11934coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11935need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11936file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11937functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11938@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11939functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11940with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11941processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11942double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11943@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11944
8e04817f
AC
11945In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11946floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11947and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11948
8e04817f
AC
11949As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11950@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11951
8e04817f
AC
11952@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11953@itemx show remotedebug
11954@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11955@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11956@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11957@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11958@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11959@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11960You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11961by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11962@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11963to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11964at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11965
8e04817f
AC
11966@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11967@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11968@itemx show timeout
11969@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11970@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11971@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11972@kindex set timeout
11973@kindex show timeout
11974@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11975@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11976You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11977remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11978default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11979waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11980retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11981You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11982retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11983@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11984
8e04817f
AC
11985The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11986is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11987forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11988to run before stopping.
11989@end table
104c1213 11990
8e04817f
AC
11991@node PowerPC
11992@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11993
11994@table @code
104c1213 11995
8e04817f
AC
11996@kindex target dink32
11997@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11998DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11999
8e04817f
AC
12000@kindex target ppcbug
12001@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12002@kindex target ppcbug1
12003@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12004PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 12005
8e04817f
AC
12006@kindex target sds
12007@item target sds @var{dev}
12008SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12009
12010@end table
12011
12012@node PA
12013@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
12014
12015@table @code
12016
8e04817f
AC
12017@kindex target op50n
12018@item target op50n @var{dev}
12019OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12020
12021@kindex target w89k
12022@item target w89k @var{dev}
12023W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
12024
12025@end table
12026
8e04817f
AC
12027@node SH
12028@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
12029
12030@table @code
12031
8e04817f
AC
12032@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12033@item target hms @var{dev}
12034A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12035commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12036the communications speed used.
104c1213 12037
8e04817f
AC
12038@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12039@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12040E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 12041
8e04817f
AC
12042@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12043@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12044@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12045@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12046Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 12047
8e04817f 12048@end table
104c1213 12049
8e04817f
AC
12050@node Sparclet
12051@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 12052
8e04817f
AC
12053@cindex Sparclet
12054
12055@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12056Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12057@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12058both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12059@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12060
8e04817f
AC
12061@table @code
12062@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12063@kindex remotetimeout
12064@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12065This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12066seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12067@end table
12068
8e04817f
AC
12069@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12070When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12071information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12072load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12073@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12074
474c8240 12075@smallexample
8e04817f 12076sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12077@end smallexample
104c1213 12078
8e04817f 12079You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12080
474c8240 12081@smallexample
8e04817f 12082sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12083@end smallexample
104c1213 12084
8e04817f
AC
12085@cindex running, on Sparclet
12086Once you have set
12087your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12088run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12089(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12090
8e04817f
AC
12091@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12092
474c8240 12093@smallexample
8e04817f 12094(gdbslet)
474c8240 12095@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12096
12097@menu
8e04817f
AC
12098* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12099* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12100* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12101* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12102@end menu
12103
8e04817f
AC
12104@node Sparclet File
12105@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12106
8e04817f 12107The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12108
474c8240 12109@smallexample
8e04817f 12110(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12111@end smallexample
104c1213 12112
8e04817f
AC
12113@need 1000
12114@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12115@value{GDBN} locates
12116the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12117path.
12118If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12119files will be searched as well.
12120@value{GDBN} locates
12121the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12122path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12123If it fails
12124to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12125
474c8240 12126@smallexample
8e04817f 12127prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12128@end smallexample
104c1213 12129
8e04817f
AC
12130When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12131the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12132@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12133
8e04817f
AC
12134@node Sparclet Connection
12135@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12136
8e04817f
AC
12137The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12138To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12139
474c8240 12140@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12141(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12142Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12143main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12144@end smallexample
104c1213 12145
8e04817f
AC
12146@need 750
12147@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12148
474c8240 12149@smallexample
8e04817f 12150Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12151@end smallexample
104c1213 12152
8e04817f
AC
12153@node Sparclet Download
12154@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12155
8e04817f
AC
12156@cindex download to Sparclet
12157Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12158you can use the @value{GDBN}
12159@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12160The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12161command.
12162Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12163address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12164offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12165of each of the file's sections.
12166For instance, if the program
12167@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12168and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12169
474c8240 12170@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12171(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12172Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12173@end smallexample
104c1213 12174
8e04817f
AC
12175If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12176to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12177to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12178
12179@node Sparclet Execution
12180@subsubsection Running and debugging
12181
12182@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12183You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12184commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12185manual for the list of commands.
12186
474c8240 12187@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12188(gdbslet) b main
12189Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12190(gdbslet) run
12191Starting program: prog
12192Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
121933 char *symarg = 0;
12194(gdbslet) step
121954 char *execarg = "hello!";
12196(gdbslet)
474c8240 12197@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12198
12199@node Sparclite
12200@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12201
12202@table @code
12203
8e04817f
AC
12204@kindex target sparclite
12205@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12206Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12207You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12208For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12209remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12210
12211@end table
12212
8e04817f
AC
12213@node ST2000
12214@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12215
8e04817f
AC
12216@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12217STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12218
8e04817f
AC
12219To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12220manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12221
474c8240 12222@smallexample
8e04817f 12223target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12224@end smallexample
104c1213 12225
8e04817f
AC
12226@noindent
12227to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12228the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12229ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12230connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12231concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12232
8e04817f
AC
12233The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12234this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12235would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12236(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12237available on your host computer.
12238@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12239@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12240
8e04817f
AC
12241@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12242These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12243environment:
104c1213 12244
8e04817f
AC
12245@table @code
12246@item st2000 @var{command}
12247@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12248@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12249@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12250Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12251manual for available commands.
104c1213 12252
8e04817f
AC
12253@item connect
12254@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12255Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12256you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12257sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12258@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12259@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12260@end table
12261
8e04817f
AC
12262@node Z8000
12263@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12264
8e04817f
AC
12265@cindex Z8000
12266@cindex simulator, Z8000
12267@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12268
8e04817f
AC
12269When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12270a Z8000 simulator.
12271
12272For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12273unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12274segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12275appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12276
8e04817f
AC
12277@table @code
12278@item target sim @var{args}
12279@kindex sim
12280@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12281Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12282options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12283@end table
12284
8e04817f
AC
12285@noindent
12286After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12287CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12288@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12289to run your program, and so on.
12290
12291As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12292(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12293additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12294
12295@table @code
12296
8e04817f
AC
12297@item cycles
12298Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12299
8e04817f
AC
12300@item insts
12301Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12302
8e04817f
AC
12303@item time
12304Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12305
8e04817f 12306@end table
104c1213 12307
8e04817f
AC
12308You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12309conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12310conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12311simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12312
8e04817f
AC
12313@node Architectures
12314@section Architectures
104c1213 12315
8e04817f
AC
12316This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12317all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12318
8e04817f
AC
12319@menu
12320* A29K::
12321* Alpha::
12322* MIPS::
12323@end menu
104c1213 12324
8e04817f
AC
12325@node A29K
12326@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12327
12328@table @code
104c1213 12329
8e04817f
AC
12330@kindex set rstack_high_address
12331@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12332@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12333@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12334On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12335@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12336extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12337stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12338memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12339this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12340the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12341address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12342hexadecimal.
104c1213 12343
8e04817f
AC
12344@kindex show rstack_high_address
12345@item show rstack_high_address
12346Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12347processors.
104c1213 12348
8e04817f 12349@end table
104c1213 12350
8e04817f
AC
12351@node Alpha
12352@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12353
8e04817f 12354See the following section.
104c1213 12355
8e04817f
AC
12356@node MIPS
12357@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12358
8e04817f
AC
12359@cindex stack on Alpha
12360@cindex stack on MIPS
12361@cindex Alpha stack
12362@cindex MIPS stack
12363Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12364sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12365find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12366
8e04817f
AC
12367@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12368To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12369@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12370you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12371commands:
104c1213 12372
8e04817f
AC
12373@table @code
12374@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12375@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12376Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12377search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12378default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12379larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12380and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12381
8e04817f
AC
12382@item show heuristic-fence-post
12383Display the current limit.
12384@end table
104c1213
JM
12385
12386@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12387These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12388for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12389
104c1213 12390
8e04817f
AC
12391@node Controlling GDB
12392@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12393
12394You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12395@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12396data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12397described here.
12398
12399@menu
12400* Prompt:: Prompt
12401* Editing:: Command editing
12402* History:: Command history
12403* Screen Size:: Screen size
12404* Numbers:: Numbers
12405* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12406* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12407@end menu
12408
12409@node Prompt
12410@section Prompt
104c1213 12411
8e04817f 12412@cindex prompt
104c1213 12413
8e04817f
AC
12414@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12415called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12416can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12417instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12418the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12419which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12420
8e04817f
AC
12421@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12422prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12423or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12424
8e04817f
AC
12425@table @code
12426@kindex set prompt
12427@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12428Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12429
8e04817f
AC
12430@kindex show prompt
12431@item show prompt
12432Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12433@end table
12434
8e04817f
AC
12435@node Editing
12436@section Command editing
12437@cindex readline
12438@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12439
8e04817f
AC
12440@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12441@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12442command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12443or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12444substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12445debugging sessions.
104c1213 12446
8e04817f
AC
12447You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12448command @code{set}.
104c1213 12449
8e04817f
AC
12450@table @code
12451@kindex set editing
12452@cindex editing
12453@item set editing
12454@itemx set editing on
12455Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12456
8e04817f
AC
12457@item set editing off
12458Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12459
8e04817f
AC
12460@kindex show editing
12461@item show editing
12462Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12463@end table
12464
8e04817f
AC
12465@node History
12466@section Command history
12467
12468@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12469debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12470happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12471history facility.
104c1213
JM
12472
12473@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12474@cindex history substitution
12475@cindex history file
12476@kindex set history filename
12477@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12478@item set history filename @var{fname}
12479Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12480This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12481list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12482exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12483the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12484to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12485@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12486is not set.
104c1213 12487
8e04817f
AC
12488@cindex history save
12489@kindex set history save
12490@item set history save
12491@itemx set history save on
12492Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12493@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12494
8e04817f
AC
12495@item set history save off
12496Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12497
8e04817f
AC
12498@cindex history size
12499@kindex set history size
12500@item set history size @var{size}
12501Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12502This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12503@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12504@end table
12505
8e04817f
AC
12506@cindex history expansion
12507History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12508@ifset have-readline-appendices
12509@xref{Event Designators}.
12510@end ifset
12511
12512Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12513is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12514@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12515follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12516a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12517history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12518@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12519
12520The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12521
12522@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12523@kindex set history expansion
12524@item set history expansion on
12525@itemx set history expansion
12526Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12527
8e04817f
AC
12528@item set history expansion off
12529Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12530
8e04817f
AC
12531The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12532editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12533or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12534@ifset have-readline-appendices
12535@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12536@end ifset
104c1213 12537
8e04817f
AC
12538@c @group
12539@kindex show history
12540@item show history
12541@itemx show history filename
12542@itemx show history save
12543@itemx show history size
12544@itemx show history expansion
12545These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12546@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12547@c @end group
12548@end table
12549
12550@table @code
12551@kindex shows
12552@item show commands
12553Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12554
8e04817f
AC
12555@item show commands @var{n}
12556Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12557
12558@item show commands +
12559Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12560@end table
12561
8e04817f
AC
12562@node Screen Size
12563@section Screen size
12564@cindex size of screen
12565@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12566
8e04817f
AC
12567Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12568information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12569@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12570output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12571to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12572determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12573printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12574rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12575
12576Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12577driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12578together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12579@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12580you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12581width} commands:
12582
12583@table @code
12584@kindex set height
12585@kindex set width
12586@kindex show width
12587@kindex show height
12588@item set height @var{lpp}
12589@itemx show height
12590@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12591@itemx show width
12592These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12593a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12594commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12595
8e04817f
AC
12596If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12597output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12598file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12599
8e04817f
AC
12600Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12601from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12602@end table
12603
8e04817f
AC
12604@node Numbers
12605@section Numbers
12606@cindex number representation
12607@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12608
8e04817f
AC
12609You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12610@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12611@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12612begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12613default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12614numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12615change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12616radix} command.
104c1213 12617
8e04817f
AC
12618@table @code
12619@kindex set input-radix
12620@item set input-radix @var{base}
12621Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12622for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12623specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12624example, any of
104c1213 12625
8e04817f
AC
12626@smallexample
12627set radix 012
12628set radix 10.
12629set radix 0xa
12630@end smallexample
104c1213 12631
8e04817f
AC
12632@noindent
12633sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12634leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12635
8e04817f
AC
12636@kindex set output-radix
12637@item set output-radix @var{base}
12638Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12639for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12640specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12641
8e04817f
AC
12642@kindex show input-radix
12643@item show input-radix
12644Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12645
8e04817f
AC
12646@kindex show output-radix
12647@item show output-radix
12648Display the current default base for numeric display.
12649@end table
104c1213 12650
8e04817f
AC
12651@node Messages/Warnings
12652@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12653
8e04817f
AC
12654By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12655running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12656command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12657internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12658
8e04817f
AC
12659Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12660which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12661see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12662
8e04817f
AC
12663@table @code
12664@kindex set verbose
12665@item set verbose on
12666Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12667
8e04817f
AC
12668@item set verbose off
12669Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12670
8e04817f
AC
12671@kindex show verbose
12672@item show verbose
12673Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12674@end table
104c1213 12675
8e04817f
AC
12676By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12677object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12678find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12679symbol files}).
104c1213 12680
8e04817f 12681@table @code
104c1213 12682
8e04817f
AC
12683@kindex set complaints
12684@item set complaints @var{limit}
12685Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12686unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12687@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12688to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12689
8e04817f
AC
12690@kindex show complaints
12691@item show complaints
12692Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12693
8e04817f 12694@end table
104c1213 12695
8e04817f
AC
12696By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12697lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12698you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12699
474c8240 12700@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12701(@value{GDBP}) run
12702The program being debugged has been started already.
12703Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12704@end smallexample
104c1213 12705
8e04817f
AC
12706If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12707commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12708
8e04817f 12709@table @code
104c1213 12710
8e04817f
AC
12711@kindex set confirm
12712@cindex flinching
12713@cindex confirmation
12714@cindex stupid questions
12715@item set confirm off
12716Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12717
8e04817f
AC
12718@item set confirm on
12719Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12720
8e04817f
AC
12721@kindex show confirm
12722@item show confirm
12723Displays state of confirmation requests.
12724
12725@end table
104c1213 12726
8e04817f
AC
12727@node Debugging Output
12728@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12729@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12730@kindex set debug arch
12731@item set debug arch
12732Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12733@kindex show debug arch
12734@item show debug arch
12735Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12736@kindex set debug event
12737@item set debug event
12738Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12739default is off.
12740@kindex show debug event
12741@item show debug event
12742Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12743info.
12744@kindex set debug expression
12745@item set debug expression
12746Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12747default is off.
12748@kindex show debug expression
12749@item show debug expression
12750Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12751debugging info.
12752@kindex set debug overload
12753@item set debug overload
12754Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12755info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12756is off.
12757@kindex show debug overload
12758@item show debug overload
12759Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12760debugging info.
12761@kindex set debug remote
12762@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12763@cindex serial connections, debugging
12764@item set debug remote
12765Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12766the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12767@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12768@kindex show debug remote
12769@item show debug remote
12770Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12771@kindex set debug serial
12772@item set debug serial
12773Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12774default is off.
12775@kindex show debug serial
12776@item show debug serial
12777Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12778info.
12779@kindex set debug target
12780@item set debug target
12781Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12782includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12783default is off.
12784@kindex show debug target
12785@item show debug target
12786Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12787info.
12788@kindex set debug varobj
12789@item set debug varobj
12790Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12791info. The default is off.
12792@kindex show debug varobj
12793@item show debug varobj
12794Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12795debugging info.
12796@end table
104c1213 12797
8e04817f
AC
12798@node Sequences
12799@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12800
8e04817f
AC
12801Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12802command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12803commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12804files.
104c1213 12805
8e04817f
AC
12806@menu
12807* Define:: User-defined commands
12808* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12809* Command Files:: Command files
12810* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12811@end menu
104c1213 12812
8e04817f
AC
12813@node Define
12814@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12815
8e04817f
AC
12816@cindex user-defined command
12817A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12818which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12819@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12820separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12821via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12822
8e04817f
AC
12823@smallexample
12824define adder
12825 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12826@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12827
12828@noindent
8e04817f 12829To execute the command use:
104c1213 12830
8e04817f
AC
12831@smallexample
12832adder 1 2 3
12833@end smallexample
104c1213 12834
8e04817f
AC
12835@noindent
12836This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12837its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12838reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12839functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12840
12841@table @code
104c1213 12842
8e04817f
AC
12843@kindex define
12844@item define @var{commandname}
12845Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12846by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12847
8e04817f
AC
12848The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12849which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12850commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12851
8e04817f
AC
12852@kindex if
12853@kindex else
12854@item if
12855Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12856It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12857only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12858There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12859by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12860was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12861
8e04817f
AC
12862@kindex while
12863@item while
12864The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12865which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12866execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12867The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12868evaluates to true.
104c1213 12869
8e04817f
AC
12870@kindex document
12871@item document @var{commandname}
12872Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12873accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12874defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12875reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12876After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12877@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12878
8e04817f
AC
12879You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12880documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12881does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12882
8e04817f
AC
12883@kindex help user-defined
12884@item help user-defined
12885List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12886(if any) for each.
104c1213 12887
8e04817f
AC
12888@kindex show user
12889@item show user
12890@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12891Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12892not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12893definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12894
20f01a46
DH
12895@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12896@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12897@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12898@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12899The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12900levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12901infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12902
104c1213
JM
12903@end table
12904
8e04817f
AC
12905When user-defined commands are executed, the
12906commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12907stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12908
8e04817f
AC
12909If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12910without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12911commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12912messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12913
8e04817f
AC
12914@node Hooks
12915@section User-defined command hooks
12916@cindex command hooks
12917@cindex hooks, for commands
12918@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12919
8e04817f
AC
12920@kindex hook
12921@kindex hook-
12922You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12923command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12924command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12925before that command.
104c1213 12926
8e04817f
AC
12927@cindex hooks, post-command
12928@kindex hookpost
12929@kindex hookpost-
12930A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12931Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12932@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12933that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12934pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12935
8e04817f
AC
12936It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12937occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12938
8e04817f
AC
12939@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12940@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12941
8e04817f
AC
12942@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12943In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12944(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12945execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12946displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12947
8e04817f
AC
12948For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12949single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12950you could define:
104c1213 12951
474c8240 12952@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12953define hook-stop
12954handle SIGALRM nopass
12955end
104c1213 12956
8e04817f
AC
12957define hook-run
12958handle SIGALRM pass
12959end
104c1213 12960
8e04817f
AC
12961define hook-continue
12962handle SIGLARM pass
12963end
474c8240 12964@end smallexample
104c1213 12965
8e04817f
AC
12966As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12967command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12968you could define:
104c1213 12969
474c8240 12970@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12971define hook-echo
12972echo <<<---
12973end
104c1213 12974
8e04817f
AC
12975define hookpost-echo
12976echo --->>>\n
12977end
104c1213 12978
8e04817f
AC
12979(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12980<<<---Hello World--->>>
12981(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12982
474c8240 12983@end smallexample
104c1213 12984
8e04817f
AC
12985You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12986not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12987name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12988@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12989@c or not?
12990If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12991@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12992(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12993
8e04817f
AC
12994If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12995get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 12996
8e04817f
AC
12997@node Command Files
12998@section Command files
c906108c 12999
8e04817f
AC
13000@cindex command files
13001A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13002commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13003An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13004the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13005
8e04817f
AC
13006@cindex init file
13007@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13008@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13009When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13010@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13011port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13012limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13013During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13014
8e04817f
AC
13015@enumerate
13016@item
13017Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13018DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13019@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13020
8e04817f
AC
13021@item
13022Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13023
8e04817f
AC
13024@item
13025Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13026
8e04817f
AC
13027@item
13028Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13029@end enumerate
c906108c 13030
8e04817f
AC
13031The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13032complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13033and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13034option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13035
8e04817f
AC
13036@cindex init file name
13037On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13038different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13039form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13040different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13041environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13042
8e04817f
AC
13043@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13044@itemize @bullet
13045@item
13046VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13047
8e04817f
AC
13048@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13049@item
13050OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13051
8e04817f
AC
13052@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13053@item
13054ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13055@end itemize
c906108c 13056
8e04817f
AC
13057You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13058@code{source} command:
c906108c 13059
8e04817f
AC
13060@table @code
13061@kindex source
13062@item source @var{filename}
13063Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13064@end table
13065
8e04817f 13066The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13067printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13068execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13069
8e04817f
AC
13070Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13071without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13072normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13073when called from command files.
c906108c 13074
8e04817f
AC
13075@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13076mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13077standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13078not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13079the next command.
c906108c 13080
474c8240 13081@smallexample
8e04817f 13082gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13083@end smallexample
c906108c 13084
8e04817f
AC
13085(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13086will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13087would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13088
8e04817f
AC
13089@node Output
13090@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13091
8e04817f
AC
13092During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13093@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13094explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13095describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13096want.
c906108c
SS
13097
13098@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13099@kindex echo
13100@item echo @var{text}
13101@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13102@c because it is not in ANSI.
13103Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13104@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13105newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13106In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13107by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13108string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13109trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13110To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13111@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13112
8e04817f
AC
13113A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13114the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13115
474c8240 13116@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13117echo This is some text\n\
13118which is continued\n\
13119onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13120@end smallexample
c906108c 13121
8e04817f 13122produces the same output as
c906108c 13123
474c8240 13124@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13125echo This is some text\n
13126echo which is continued\n
13127echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13128@end smallexample
c906108c 13129
8e04817f
AC
13130@kindex output
13131@item output @var{expression}
13132Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13133newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13134value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13135on expressions.
c906108c 13136
8e04817f
AC
13137@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13138Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13139the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13140formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13141
8e04817f
AC
13142@kindex printf
13143@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13144Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13145@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13146either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13147@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13148subroutine
13149@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13150@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13151@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13152@c supported.
c906108c 13153
474c8240 13154@smallexample
8e04817f 13155printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13156@end smallexample
c906108c 13157
8e04817f 13158For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13159
8e04817f
AC
13160@smallexample
13161printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13162@end smallexample
c906108c 13163
8e04817f
AC
13164The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13165string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13166letter.
c906108c
SS
13167@end table
13168
8e04817f
AC
13169@node TUI
13170@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13171@cindex TUI
c906108c 13172
8e04817f
AC
13173@menu
13174* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13175* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13176* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13177* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13178* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13179@end menu
c906108c 13180
8e04817f
AC
13181The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13182is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13183to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13184and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13185The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13186with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13187
8e04817f
AC
13188@node TUI Overview
13189@section TUI overview
c906108c 13190
8e04817f
AC
13191The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13192@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13193
8e04817f
AC
13194@itemize @bullet
13195@item
13196A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13197windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13198
8e04817f
AC
13199@item
13200A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13201the TUI.
13202@end itemize
c906108c 13203
8e04817f
AC
13204In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13205on the terminal:
c906108c 13206
8e04817f
AC
13207@table @emph
13208@item command
13209This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13210prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13211managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13212window is always visible.
c906108c 13213
8e04817f
AC
13214@item source
13215The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13216line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13217
8e04817f
AC
13218@item assembly
13219The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13220
8e04817f
AC
13221@item register
13222This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13223a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13224changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13225
c906108c
SS
13226@end table
13227
269c21fe
SC
13228The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13229by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13230Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13231indicates the breakpoint type:
13232
13233@table @code
13234@item B
13235Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13236
13237@item b
13238Breakpoint which was never hit.
13239
13240@item H
13241Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13242
13243@item h
13244Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13245
13246@end table
13247
13248The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13249
13250@table @code
13251@item +
13252Breakpoint is enabled.
13253
13254@item -
13255Breakpoint is disabled.
13256
13257@end table
13258
8e04817f
AC
13259The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13260and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13261changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13262These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13263layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13264The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13265
8e04817f
AC
13266@itemize @bullet
13267@item
13268source
2df3850c 13269
8e04817f
AC
13270@item
13271assembly
13272
13273@item
13274source and assembly
13275
13276@item
13277source and registers
c906108c 13278
8e04817f
AC
13279@item
13280assembly and registers
2df3850c 13281
8e04817f 13282@end itemize
c906108c 13283
b7bb15bc
SC
13284On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13285concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13286updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13287are displayed:
13288
13289@table @emph
13290@item target
13291Indicates the current gdb target
13292(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13293
13294@item process
13295Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13296When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13297
13298@item function
13299Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13300The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13301When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13302the string @code{??} is displayed.
13303
13304@item line
13305Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13306When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13307
13308@item pc
13309Indicates the current program counter address.
13310
13311@end table
13312
8e04817f
AC
13313@node TUI Keys
13314@section TUI Key Bindings
13315@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13316
8e04817f
AC
13317The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13318(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13319They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13320directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13321a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13322@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13323are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13324
8e04817f
AC
13325@table @kbd
13326@kindex C-x C-a
13327@item C-x C-a
13328@kindex C-x a
13329@itemx C-x a
13330@kindex C-x A
13331@itemx C-x A
13332Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13333the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13334its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13335mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13336The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13337
8e04817f
AC
13338@kindex C-x 1
13339@item C-x 1
13340Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13341either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13342is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13343
8e04817f 13344Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13345
8e04817f
AC
13346@kindex C-x 2
13347@item C-x 2
13348Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13349layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13350When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13351previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13352
8e04817f 13353Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13354
7cf36c78
SC
13355@kindex C-x s
13356@item C-x s
13357Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13358(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13359
c906108c
SS
13360@end table
13361
8e04817f 13362The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13363
8e04817f
AC
13364@table @key
13365@kindex PgUp
13366@item PgUp
13367Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13368
8e04817f
AC
13369@kindex PgDn
13370@item PgDn
13371Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13372
8e04817f
AC
13373@kindex Up
13374@item Up
13375Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13376
8e04817f
AC
13377@kindex Down
13378@item Down
13379Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13380
8e04817f
AC
13381@kindex Left
13382@item Left
13383Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13384
8e04817f
AC
13385@kindex Right
13386@item Right
13387Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13388
8e04817f
AC
13389@kindex C-L
13390@item C-L
13391Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13392
8e04817f 13393@end table
c906108c 13394
8e04817f
AC
13395In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13396for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13397necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13398@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13399
7cf36c78
SC
13400@node TUI Single Key Mode
13401@section TUI Single Key Mode
13402@cindex TUI single key mode
13403
13404The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13405key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13406some gdb commands.
13407
13408@table @kbd
13409@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13410@item c
13411continue
13412
13413@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13414@item d
13415down
13416
13417@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13418@item f
13419finish
13420
13421@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13422@item n
13423next
13424
13425@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13426@item q
13427exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13428
13429@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13430@item r
13431run
13432
13433@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13434@item s
13435step
13436
13437@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13438@item u
13439up
13440
13441@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13442@item v
13443info locals
13444
13445@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13446@item w
13447where
13448
13449@end table
13450
13451Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13452The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13453it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13454with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13455@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13456this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13457
13458
8e04817f
AC
13459@node TUI Commands
13460@section TUI specific commands
13461@cindex TUI commands
13462
13463The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13464These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13465the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13466is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13467in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13468
13469@table @code
3d757584
SC
13470@item info win
13471@kindex info win
13472List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13473
8e04817f
AC
13474@item layout next
13475@kindex layout next
13476Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13477
8e04817f
AC
13478@item layout prev
13479@kindex layout prev
13480Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13481
8e04817f
AC
13482@item layout src
13483@kindex layout src
13484Display the source window only.
c906108c 13485
8e04817f
AC
13486@item layout asm
13487@kindex layout asm
13488Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13489
8e04817f
AC
13490@item layout split
13491@kindex layout split
13492Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13493
8e04817f
AC
13494@item layout regs
13495@kindex layout regs
13496Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13497
13498@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13499@kindex focus
13500Set the focus to the named window.
13501This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13502can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13503
8e04817f
AC
13504@item refresh
13505@kindex refresh
13506Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13507
8e04817f
AC
13508@item update
13509@kindex update
13510Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13511
8e04817f
AC
13512@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13513@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13514@kindex winheight
13515Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13516lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13517decrease it.
2df3850c 13518
c906108c
SS
13519@end table
13520
8e04817f
AC
13521@node TUI Configuration
13522@section TUI configuration variables
13523@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13524
8e04817f
AC
13525The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13526appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13527
8e04817f
AC
13528@table @code
13529@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13530@kindex set tui border-kind
13531Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13532The possible values are the following:
13533@table @code
13534@item space
13535Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13536
8e04817f
AC
13537@item ascii
13538Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13539
8e04817f
AC
13540@item acs
13541Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13542drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13543
8e04817f 13544@end table
c78b4128 13545
8e04817f
AC
13546@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13547@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13548Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13549The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13550@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13551
8e04817f
AC
13552@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13553@kindex set tui border-mode
13554Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13555The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13556@table @code
13557@item normal
13558Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13559
8e04817f
AC
13560@item standout
13561Use standout mode.
c906108c 13562
8e04817f
AC
13563@item reverse
13564Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13565
8e04817f
AC
13566@item half
13567Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13568
8e04817f
AC
13569@item half-standout
13570Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13571
8e04817f
AC
13572@item bold
13573Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13574
8e04817f
AC
13575@item bold-standout
13576Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13577
8e04817f 13578@end table
c78b4128 13579
8e04817f 13580@end table
c78b4128 13581
8e04817f
AC
13582@node Emacs
13583@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13584
8e04817f
AC
13585@cindex Emacs
13586@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13587A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13588edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13589@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13590
8e04817f
AC
13591To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13592executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13593@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13594created Emacs buffer.
13595@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13596
8e04817f
AC
13597Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13598things:
c906108c 13599
8e04817f
AC
13600@itemize @bullet
13601@item
13602All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13603@end itemize
c906108c 13604
8e04817f
AC
13605This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13606and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13607
8e04817f
AC
13608This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13609commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13610in this way.
bf0184be 13611
8e04817f
AC
13612All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13613with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13614way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13615stop.
bf0184be 13616
8e04817f 13617@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13618@item
8e04817f
AC
13619@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13620@end itemize
bf0184be 13621
8e04817f
AC
13622Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13623source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13624left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13625source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13626and the source.
bf0184be 13627
8e04817f
AC
13628Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13629usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13630
8e04817f
AC
13631@quotation
13632@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13633current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13634the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13635appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13636environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13637session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13638back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13639avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13640your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13641@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13642
8e04817f
AC
13643A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13644switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13645@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13646@end quotation
13647
13648By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13649you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13650several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13651Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13652
474c8240 13653@smallexample
8e04817f 13654(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13655@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13656
13657@noindent
13658(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13659in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13660``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13661
13662In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13663addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13664
8e04817f
AC
13665@table @kbd
13666@item C-h m
13667Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13668
8e04817f
AC
13669@item M-s
13670Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13671update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13672
8e04817f
AC
13673@item M-n
13674Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13675calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13676to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13677
8e04817f
AC
13678@item M-i
13679Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13680display window accordingly.
c906108c 13681
8e04817f
AC
13682@item M-x gdb-nexti
13683Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13684display window accordingly.
c906108c 13685
8e04817f
AC
13686@item C-c C-f
13687Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13688@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13689
8e04817f
AC
13690@item M-c
13691Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13692command.
b433d00b 13693
8e04817f 13694@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13695
8e04817f
AC
13696@item M-u
13697Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13698(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13699like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13700
8e04817f 13701@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13702
8e04817f
AC
13703@item M-d
13704Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13705@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13706
8e04817f 13707@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13708
8e04817f
AC
13709@item C-x &
13710Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13711of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13712around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13713then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13714argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13715
8e04817f
AC
13716You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13717@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13718otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13719inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13720wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13721list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13722formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13723is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13724@end table
c906108c 13725
8e04817f
AC
13726In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13727tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13728
8e04817f
AC
13729If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13730it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13731request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13732the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13733frame.
c906108c 13734
8e04817f
AC
13735The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13736which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13737the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13738communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13739delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13740to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13741
8e04817f
AC
13742@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13743@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13744@ignore
13745@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13746@kindex Epoch
13747@kindex inspect
c906108c 13748
8e04817f
AC
13749Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13750called the @code{epoch}
13751environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13752@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13753each value is printed in its own window.
13754@end ignore
c906108c 13755
8e04817f
AC
13756@include annotate.texi
13757@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13758
8e04817f
AC
13759@node GDB Bugs
13760@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13761@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13762@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13763
8e04817f 13764Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13765
8e04817f
AC
13766Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13767may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13768the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13769reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13770
8e04817f
AC
13771In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13772information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13773
13774@menu
8e04817f
AC
13775* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13776* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13777@end menu
13778
8e04817f
AC
13779@node Bug Criteria
13780@section Have you found a bug?
13781@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13782
8e04817f 13783If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13784
13785@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13786@cindex fatal signal
13787@cindex debugger crash
13788@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13789@item
8e04817f
AC
13790If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13791@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13792
13793@cindex error on valid input
13794@item
13795If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13796bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13797somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13798
8e04817f 13799@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13800@item
8e04817f
AC
13801If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13802that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13803``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13804for traditional practice''.
13805
13806@item
13807If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13808for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13809@end itemize
13810
8e04817f
AC
13811@node Bug Reporting
13812@section How to report bugs
13813@cindex bug reports
13814@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13815
13816A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13817If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13818contact that organization first.
13819
13820You can find contact information for many support companies and
13821individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13822distribution.
13823@c should add a web page ref...
13824
129188f6
AC
13825In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13826@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13827@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13828page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13829be used.
8e04817f
AC
13830
13831@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13832@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13833not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13834@samp{bug-gdb}.
13835
13836The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13837serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13838the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13839newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13840problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13841path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13842we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13843bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13844
8e04817f
AC
13845The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13846@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13847fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13848
8e04817f
AC
13849Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13850problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13851assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13852Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13853stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13854name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13855of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13856the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13857easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13858
8e04817f
AC
13859Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13860bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13861you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13862self-contained.
c4555f82 13863
8e04817f
AC
13864Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13865bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13866@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13867bugs properly.
13868
13869To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13870
13871@itemize @bullet
13872@item
8e04817f
AC
13873The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13874with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13875version}.
c4555f82 13876
8e04817f
AC
13877Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13878the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13879
13880@item
8e04817f
AC
13881The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13882version number.
c4555f82
SC
13883
13884@item
8e04817f
AC
13885What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13886``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13887
13888@item
8e04817f
AC
13889What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13890debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13891C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13892information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13893compilers.
c4555f82 13894
8e04817f
AC
13895@item
13896The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13897observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13898you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13899Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13900
8e04817f
AC
13901If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13902and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13903
8e04817f
AC
13904@item
13905A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13906reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13907
8e04817f
AC
13908@item
13909A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13910incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13911
8e04817f
AC
13912Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13913will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13914not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13915a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13916
8e04817f
AC
13917Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13918say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13919copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13920the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13921crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13922ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13923us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13924to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13925
8e04817f
AC
13926@item
13927If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13928diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13929it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13930
8e04817f
AC
13931The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13932sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13933
8e04817f 13934@end itemize
c4555f82 13935
8e04817f 13936Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13937
8e04817f
AC
13938@itemize @bullet
13939@item
13940A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13941
8e04817f
AC
13942Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13943which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13944changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13945
8e04817f
AC
13946This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13947will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13948with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13949We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13950
8e04817f
AC
13951Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13952of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13953output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13954less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13955
8e04817f
AC
13956However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13957report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13958
8e04817f
AC
13959@item
13960A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13961
8e04817f
AC
13962A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13963the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13964a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13965to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13966
8e04817f
AC
13967Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13968construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13969through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13970to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13971
8e04817f
AC
13972And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13973patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13974help us to understand.
c4555f82 13975
8e04817f
AC
13976@item
13977A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13978
8e04817f
AC
13979Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13980things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13981@end itemize
c4555f82 13982
8e04817f
AC
13983@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13984@c and consists of the two following files:
13985@c rluser.texinfo
13986@c inc-hist.texinfo
13987@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13988@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13989@include rluser.texinfo
13990@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13991
c4555f82 13992
8e04817f
AC
13993@node Formatting Documentation
13994@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 13995
8e04817f
AC
13996@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13997@cindex reference card
13998The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13999for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14000subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14001@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14002release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14003you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 14004
8e04817f
AC
14005The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14006can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 14007
474c8240 14008@smallexample
8e04817f 14009make refcard.dvi
474c8240 14010@end smallexample
c4555f82 14011
8e04817f
AC
14012The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14013mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
14014that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14015high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14016your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 14017
8e04817f 14018@cindex documentation
c4555f82 14019
8e04817f
AC
14020All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14021distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14022a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14023on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14024formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14025and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 14026
8e04817f
AC
14027@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14028version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14029file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14030subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14031necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14032but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14033Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14034@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 14035
8e04817f
AC
14036If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14037Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14038@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 14039
8e04817f
AC
14040If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14041@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14042version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 14043
474c8240 14044@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14045cd gdb
14046make gdb.info
474c8240 14047@end smallexample
c4555f82 14048
8e04817f
AC
14049If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14050a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14051Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 14052
8e04817f
AC
14053@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14054produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14055document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14056has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14057command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14058(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14059require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 14060
8e04817f
AC
14061@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14062@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14063written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14064typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14065and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14066directory.
c4555f82 14067
8e04817f
AC
14068If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14069typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14070subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14071@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 14072
474c8240 14073@smallexample
8e04817f 14074make gdb.dvi
474c8240 14075@end smallexample
c4555f82 14076
8e04817f 14077Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 14078
8e04817f
AC
14079@node Installing GDB
14080@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14081@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14082@cindex installation
c4555f82 14083
8e04817f
AC
14084@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14085of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14086build the @code{gdb} program.
14087@iftex
14088@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14089@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14090look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14091installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14092@end iftex
c4555f82 14093
8e04817f
AC
14094The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14095@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14096appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 14097
8e04817f
AC
14098For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14099@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 14100
8e04817f
AC
14101@table @code
14102@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14103script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 14104
8e04817f
AC
14105@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14106the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 14107
8e04817f
AC
14108@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14109source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 14110
8e04817f
AC
14111@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14112@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14113
8e04817f
AC
14114@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14115source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14116
8e04817f
AC
14117@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14118source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14119
8e04817f
AC
14120@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14121source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14122
8e04817f
AC
14123@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14124source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14125
8e04817f
AC
14126@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14127source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14128@end table
c906108c 14129
8e04817f
AC
14130The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14131from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14132this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14133
8e04817f
AC
14134First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14135if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14136identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14137argument.
c906108c 14138
8e04817f 14139For example:
c906108c 14140
474c8240 14141@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14142cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14143./configure @var{host}
14144make
474c8240 14145@end smallexample
c906108c 14146
8e04817f
AC
14147@noindent
14148where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14149@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14150(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14151correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14152
8e04817f
AC
14153Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14154@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14155libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14156binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14157
8e04817f
AC
14158@need 750
14159@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14160system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14161shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14162
474c8240 14163@smallexample
8e04817f 14164sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14165@end smallexample
c906108c 14166
8e04817f
AC
14167If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14168directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14169@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14170creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14171you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14172
14173You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
14174subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
14175configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 14176
8e04817f
AC
14177For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
14178the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 14179
474c8240 14180@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14181@group
14182cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14183../configure @var{host}
14184@end group
474c8240 14185@end smallexample
c906108c 14186
8e04817f
AC
14187You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14188However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14189the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14190that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14191let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14192
8e04817f
AC
14193@menu
14194* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14195* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14196* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14197@end menu
c906108c 14198
8e04817f
AC
14199@node Separate Objdir
14200@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14201
8e04817f
AC
14202If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14203you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14204host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14205allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14206rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14207handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14208@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14209program specified there.
c906108c 14210
8e04817f
AC
14211To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14212with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14213(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14214itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14215would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14216the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14217
8e04817f
AC
14218For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14219separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14220
474c8240 14221@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14222@group
14223cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14224mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14225cd ../gdb-sun4
14226../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14227make
14228@end group
474c8240 14229@end smallexample
c906108c 14230
8e04817f
AC
14231When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14232directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14233(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14234the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14235directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14236@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14237
8e04817f
AC
14238One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14239directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14240@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14241programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14242You specify a cross-debugging target by
14243giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14244
8e04817f
AC
14245When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14246it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14247called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14248
8e04817f
AC
14249The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14250directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14251directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14252directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14253will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14254
8e04817f
AC
14255When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14256directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14257if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14258with each other.
c906108c 14259
8e04817f
AC
14260@node Config Names
14261@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14262
8e04817f
AC
14263The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14264script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14265aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14266of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14267
474c8240 14268@smallexample
8e04817f 14269@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14270@end smallexample
c906108c 14271
8e04817f
AC
14272For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14273or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14274option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14275
8e04817f
AC
14276The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14277any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14278aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14279@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14280script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14281abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14282
8e04817f
AC
14283@smallexample
14284% sh config.sub i386-linux
14285i386-pc-linux-gnu
14286% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14287alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14288% sh config.sub hp9k700
14289hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14290% sh config.sub sun4
14291sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14292% sh config.sub sun3
14293m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14294% sh config.sub i986v
14295Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14296@end smallexample
c906108c 14297
8e04817f
AC
14298@noindent
14299@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14300directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14301
8e04817f
AC
14302@node Configure Options
14303@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14304
8e04817f
AC
14305Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14306are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14307several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14308Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14309
474c8240 14310@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14311configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14312 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14313 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14314 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14315 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14316 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14317 @var{host}
474c8240 14318@end smallexample
c906108c 14319
8e04817f
AC
14320@noindent
14321You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14322@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14323@samp{--}.
c906108c 14324
8e04817f
AC
14325@table @code
14326@item --help
14327Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14328
8e04817f
AC
14329@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14330Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14331@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14332
8e04817f
AC
14333@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14334Configure the source to install programs under directory
14335@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14336
8e04817f
AC
14337@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14338@need 2000
14339@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14340@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14341@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14342Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14343@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14344build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14345directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14346the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14347directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14348the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14349@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14350
8e04817f
AC
14351@item --norecursion
14352Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14353propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14354
8e04817f
AC
14355@item --target=@var{target}
14356Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14357@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14358programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14359
8e04817f 14360There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14361
8e04817f
AC
14362@item @var{host} @dots{}
14363Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14364
8e04817f
AC
14365There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14366@end table
c906108c 14367
8e04817f
AC
14368There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14369needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14370
8e04817f
AC
14371@node Maintenance Commands
14372@appendix Maintenance Commands
14373@cindex maintenance commands
14374@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14375
8e04817f
AC
14376In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14377includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14378These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14379
8e04817f
AC
14380@table @code
14381@kindex maint info breakpoints
14382@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14383Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14384breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14385internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14386breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14387is shown:
c906108c 14388
8e04817f
AC
14389@table @code
14390@item breakpoint
14391Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14392
8e04817f
AC
14393@item watchpoint
14394Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14395
8e04817f
AC
14396@item longjmp
14397Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14398@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14399
8e04817f
AC
14400@item longjmp resume
14401Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14402
8e04817f
AC
14403@item until
14404Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14405
8e04817f
AC
14406@item finish
14407Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14408
8e04817f
AC
14409@item shlib events
14410Shared library events.
c906108c 14411
8e04817f 14412@end table
c906108c 14413
8d30a00d
AC
14414@kindex maint internal-error
14415@kindex maint internal-warning
14416@item maint internal-error
14417@itemx maint internal-warning
14418Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14419or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14420or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14421internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14422either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14423@value{GDBN} session.
14424
14425@smallexample
14426(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14427@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14428A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14429debugging may prove unreliable.
14430Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14431Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14432(gdb)
14433@end smallexample
14434
14435Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14436warning message.
14437
0680b120
AC
14438@kindex maint print registers
14439@kindex maint print raw-registers
14440@kindex maint print cooked-registers
14441@item maint print registers
14442@itemx maint print raw-registers
14443@itemx maint print cooked-registers
14444Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14445
14446The command @samp{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14447the raw register cache; and the command @samp{maint print
14448cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers.
14449@xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint, @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14450
14451Takes an optional file parameter.
14452
8e04817f 14453@end table
c906108c 14454
c906108c 14455
e0ce93ac 14456@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14457@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14458
ee2d5c50
AC
14459@menu
14460* Overview::
14461* Packets::
14462* Stop Reply Packets::
14463* General Query Packets::
14464* Register Packet Format::
14465* Examples::
14466@end menu
14467
14468@node Overview
14469@section Overview
14470
8e04817f
AC
14471There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14472protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14473machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14474recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14475
d2c6833e 14476In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14477transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14478
8e04817f
AC
14479@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14480@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14481@cindex remote serial protocol
14482All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14483sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14484@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14485@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14486
474c8240 14487@smallexample
8e04817f 14488@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14489@end smallexample
8e04817f 14490@noindent
c906108c 14491
8e04817f
AC
14492@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14493@noindent
14494The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14495characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14496eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14497
8e04817f
AC
14498Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14499specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14500
474c8240 14501@smallexample
8e04817f 14502@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14503@end smallexample
c906108c 14504
8e04817f
AC
14505@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14506@noindent
14507That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14508has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14509since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14510
8e04817f
AC
14511@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14512When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14513response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14514the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14515retransmission):
c906108c 14516
474c8240 14517@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14518-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14519<- @code{+}
474c8240 14520@end smallexample
8e04817f 14521@noindent
53a5351d 14522
8e04817f
AC
14523The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14524debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14525the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14526when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14527
8e04817f
AC
14528@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14529exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14530exceptions).
c906108c 14531
8e04817f 14532Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14533@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14534@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14535@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14536
8e04817f
AC
14537Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14538@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14539would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14540
8e04817f
AC
14541Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14542means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14543which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14544@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14545where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14546characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14547value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14548
8e04817f
AC
14549Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14550loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14551character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14552
8e04817f 14553So:
474c8240 14554@smallexample
8e04817f 14555"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14556@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14557@noindent
14558means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14559
8e04817f
AC
14560The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14561error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14562
8e04817f
AC
14563For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14564(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14565protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14566on that response.
c906108c 14567
8e04817f
AC
14568A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14569@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14570optional.
c906108c 14571
ee2d5c50
AC
14572@node Packets
14573@section Packets
14574
14575The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14576@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14577
14578@table @r
14579
14580@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14581@cindex @code{!} packet
14582
8e04817f
AC
14583Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14584persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14585debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14586
14587Reply:
14588@table @samp
14589@item OK
8e04817f 14590The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14591@end table
c906108c 14592
ee2d5c50
AC
14593@item @code{?} --- last signal
14594@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14595
ee2d5c50
AC
14596Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14597step and continue.
c906108c 14598
ee2d5c50
AC
14599Reply:
14600@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14601
14602@item @code{a} --- reserved
14603
14604Reserved for future use.
14605
14606@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14607@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14608
8e04817f
AC
14609Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14610specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14611See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14612
14613Reply:
14614@table @samp
14615@item OK
14616@item E@var{NN}
14617@end table
14618
14619@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14620@cindex @code{b} packet
14621
14622Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14623
14624JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14625received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14626problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14627
14628Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14629it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14630some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14631switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14632of view, nothing actually happened.}
14633
14634@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14635@cindex @code{B} packet
14636
8e04817f 14637Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14638breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14639
14640This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14641(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14642
ee2d5c50
AC
14643@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14644@cindex @code{c} packet
14645
14646@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14647current address.
c906108c 14648
ee2d5c50
AC
14649Reply:
14650@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14651
14652@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14653@cindex @code{C} packet
14654
8e04817f
AC
14655Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14656@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14657
ee2d5c50
AC
14658Reply:
14659@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14660
ee2d5c50
AC
14661@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14662@cindex @code{d} packet
14663
14664Toggle debug flag.
14665
14666@item @code{D} --- detach
14667@cindex @code{D} packet
14668
14669Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14670before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14671
14672Reply:
14673@table @samp
14674@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14675@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14676@end table
c906108c 14677
ee2d5c50 14678@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14679
ee2d5c50 14680Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14681
ee2d5c50 14682@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14683
ee2d5c50 14684Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14685
ee2d5c50
AC
14686@item @code{f} --- reserved
14687
14688Reserved for future use.
14689
14690@item @code{F} --- reserved
14691
14692Reserved for future use.
14693
14694@item @code{g} --- read registers
14695@anchor{read registers packet}
14696@cindex @code{g} packet
14697
14698Read general registers.
14699
14700Reply:
14701@table @samp
14702@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14703Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14704with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14705each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14706determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14707and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14708@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14709@item E@var{NN}
14710for an error.
14711@end table
c906108c 14712
ee2d5c50
AC
14713@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14714@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14715
ee2d5c50
AC
14716@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14717data.
14718
14719Reply:
14720@table @samp
14721@item OK
14722for success
14723@item E@var{NN}
14724for an error
14725@end table
14726
14727@item @code{h} --- reserved
14728
14729Reserved for future use.
14730
14731@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14732@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14733
8e04817f 14734Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14735@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14736should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14737operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14738the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14739
14740Reply:
14741@table @samp
14742@item OK
14743for success
14744@item E@var{NN}
14745for an error
14746@end table
c906108c 14747
8e04817f
AC
14748@c FIXME: JTC:
14749@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14750@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14751@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14752@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14753@c described. For example:
14754@c
14755@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14756@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14757@c otherwise returns current registers.
14758@c
14759@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14760@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14761@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14762
ee2d5c50
AC
14763@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14764@anchor{cycle step packet}
14765@cindex @code{i} packet
14766
8e04817f
AC
14767Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14768present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14769step starting at that address.
c906108c 14770
ee2d5c50
AC
14771@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14772@cindex @code{I} packet
14773
14774@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14775
14776@item @code{j} --- reserved
14777
14778Reserved for future use.
14779
14780@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 14781
ee2d5c50 14782Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14783
ee2d5c50
AC
14784@item @code{k} --- kill request
14785@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 14786
ac282366 14787FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
14788thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14789thread?)}.
c906108c 14790
ee2d5c50 14791@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 14792
ee2d5c50
AC
14793Reserved for future use.
14794
14795@item @code{l} --- reserved
14796
14797Reserved for future use.
14798
14799@item @code{L} --- reserved
14800
14801Reserved for future use.
14802
14803@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14804@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 14805
8e04817f 14806Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14807Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
14808assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 14809transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 14810
ee2d5c50
AC
14811Reply:
14812@table @samp
14813@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14814@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14815to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
14816that sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned
14817accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14818needed.}
14819@item E@var{NN}
14820@var{NN} is errno
14821@end table
14822
14823@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14824@cindex @code{M} packet
14825
8e04817f 14826Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14827@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14828
14829Reply:
14830@table @samp
14831@item OK
14832for success
14833@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
14834for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14835written).
ee2d5c50 14836@end table
c906108c 14837
ee2d5c50 14838@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 14839
ee2d5c50 14840Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14841
ee2d5c50 14842@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 14843
ee2d5c50 14844Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14845
ee2d5c50
AC
14846@item @code{o} --- reserved
14847
14848Reserved for future use.
14849
14850@item @code{O} --- reserved
14851
14852Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14853
ee2d5c50
AC
14854@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14855@cindex @code{p} packet
14856
14857@xref{write register packet}.
14858
14859Reply:
14860@table @samp
14861@item @var{r@dots{}.}
14862The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14863@end table
14864
14865@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
14866@anchor{write register packet}
14867@cindex @code{P} packet
14868
14869Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 14870digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 14871
ee2d5c50
AC
14872Reply:
14873@table @samp
14874@item OK
14875for success
14876@item E@var{NN}
14877for an error
14878@end table
14879
14880@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
14881@anchor{general query packet}
14882@cindex @code{q} packet
14883
14884Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
14885leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
14886prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
14887be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
14888that they match the full @var{query} name.
14889
14890Reply:
14891@table @samp
14892@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14893Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14894@item E@var{NN}
14895error reply
8e04817f 14896@item
ee2d5c50
AC
14897Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14898@end table
14899
14900@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
14901@cindex @code{Q} packet
14902
14903Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
14904
14905@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 14906
ee2d5c50
AC
14907@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14908@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 14909
8e04817f 14910Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14911
ee2d5c50
AC
14912@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
14913@cindex @code{R} packet
14914
8e04817f
AC
14915Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14916This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
14917
14918Reply:
14919@table @samp
14920@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 14921The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
14922@end table
14923
14924@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
14925@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 14926
8e04817f
AC
14927@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14928same address.
c906108c 14929
ee2d5c50
AC
14930Reply:
14931@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14932
14933@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
14934@anchor{step with signal packet}
14935@cindex @code{S} packet
14936
8e04817f 14937Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 14938
ee2d5c50
AC
14939Reply:
14940@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14941
14942@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
14943@cindex @code{t} packet
14944
8e04817f 14945Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
14946@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
14947@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14948
ee2d5c50
AC
14949@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
14950@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 14951
ee2d5c50 14952Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 14953
ee2d5c50
AC
14954Reply:
14955@table @samp
14956@item OK
14957thread is still alive
14958@item E@var{NN}
14959thread is dead
14960@end table
14961
14962@item @code{u} --- reserved
14963
14964Reserved for future use.
14965
14966@item @code{U} --- reserved
14967
14968Reserved for future use.
14969
14970@item @code{v} --- reserved
14971
14972Reserved for future use.
14973
14974@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 14975
ee2d5c50 14976Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14977
ee2d5c50 14978@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 14979
ee2d5c50 14980Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14981
ee2d5c50 14982@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 14983
ee2d5c50 14984Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14985
ee2d5c50
AC
14986@item @code{x} --- reserved
14987
14988Reserved for future use.
14989
14990@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
14991@cindex @code{X} packet
14992
14993@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
14994is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 14995escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 14996
ee2d5c50
AC
14997Reply:
14998@table @samp
14999@item OK
15000for success
15001@item E@var{NN}
15002for an error
15003@end table
15004
15005@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 15006
ee2d5c50 15007Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15008
ee2d5c50
AC
15009@item @code{Y} reserved
15010
15011Reserved for future use.
15012
2f870471
AC
15013@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15014@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15015@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 15016@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 15017@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 15018
2f870471
AC
15019Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
15020watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
15021@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 15022
2f870471
AC
15023Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
15024separately.
15025
15026@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return @samp{} for an
15027unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A remote
15028target shall support either both or neither of a given
15029@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
15030avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
15031be implemented in an idempotent way.}
15032
15033@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15034@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15035@cindex @code{z0} packet
15036@cindex @code{Z0} packet
15037
15038Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
15039@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15040
15041A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
15042@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
15043@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
15044breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
15045@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 15046
2f870471
AC
15047@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
15048code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
15049overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
15050target, is not defined.}
c906108c 15051
ee2d5c50
AC
15052Reply:
15053@table @samp
2f870471
AC
15054@item OK
15055success
15056@item
15057not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
15058@item E@var{NN}
15059for an error
2f870471
AC
15060@end table
15061
15062@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15063@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15064@cindex @code{z1} packet
15065@cindex @code{Z1} packet
15066
15067Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15068address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15069
15070A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15071dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15072
15073@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15074movement.}
15075
15076Reply:
15077@table @samp
ee2d5c50 15078@item OK
2f870471
AC
15079success
15080@item
15081not supported
15082@item E@var{NN}
15083for an error
15084@end table
15085
15086@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15087@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15088@cindex @code{z2} packet
15089@cindex @code{Z2} packet
15090
15091Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15092
15093Reply:
15094@table @samp
15095@item OK
15096success
15097@item
15098not supported
15099@item E@var{NN}
15100for an error
15101@end table
15102
15103@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15104@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15105@cindex @code{z3} packet
15106@cindex @code{Z3} packet
15107
15108Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a write watchpoint.
15109
15110Reply:
15111@table @samp
15112@item OK
15113success
15114@item
15115not supported
15116@item E@var{NN}
15117for an error
15118@end table
15119
15120@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15121@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15122@cindex @code{z4} packet
15123@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15124
15125Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15126
15127Reply:
15128@table @samp
15129@item OK
15130success
15131@item
15132not supported
15133@item E@var{NN}
15134for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15135@end table
15136
15137@end table
c906108c 15138
ee2d5c50
AC
15139@node Stop Reply Packets
15140@section Stop Reply Packets
15141@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15142
8e04817f
AC
15143The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15144receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15145@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15146when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15147number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15148conventions is used.
c906108c 15149
ee2d5c50 15150@table @samp
c906108c 15151
ee2d5c50
AC
15152@item S@var{AA}
15153@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15154
8e04817f 15155@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15156@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15157
8e04817f
AC
15158@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15159(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15160by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15161thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15162@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15163integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15164@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15165to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15166
ee2d5c50
AC
15167@item W@var{AA}
15168
8e04817f 15169The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15170applicable to certain targets.
15171
15172@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15173
8e04817f 15174The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15175
ee2d5c50
AC
15176@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15177
15178@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15179@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15180base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15181The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15182the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15183is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15184
ee2d5c50 15185@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15186
ee2d5c50
AC
15187@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15188any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15189to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15190
15191@end table
15192
15193@node General Query Packets
15194@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15195
8e04817f 15196The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15197
ee2d5c50 15198@table @r
c906108c 15199
ee2d5c50
AC
15200@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15201
15202Return the current thread id.
15203
15204Reply:
15205@table @samp
15206@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15207Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15208@item *
15209Any other reply implies the old pid.
15210@end table
15211
15212@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15213
15214@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15215
8e04817f
AC
15216Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15217may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15218works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15219obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15220be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15221sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15222
15223NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15224
15225Reply:
15226@table @samp
15227@item @code{m}@var{id}
15228A single thread id
15229@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15230a comma-separated list of thread ids
15231@item @code{l}
15232(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15233@end table
15234
15235In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15236more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15237will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15238@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15239(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15240
ee2d5c50
AC
15241@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15242
15243Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15244string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15245string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15246@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15247in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15248possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15249Mutex''.
15250
15251Reply:
15252@table @samp
15253@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15254Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15255the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15256attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15257@end table
15258
15259@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15260
8e04817f
AC
15261Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15262digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15263subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15264number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15265(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15266returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15267
15268NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15269(see above).
15270
15271Reply:
15272@table @samp
15273@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15274Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15275returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15276and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15277digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15278is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15279digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15280@end table
c906108c 15281
ee2d5c50
AC
15282@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15283
15284Reply:
15285@table @samp
15286@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15287An error (such as memory fault)
15288@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15289A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15290@end table
15291
15292@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15293
8e04817f
AC
15294Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15295image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15296response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15297offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15298
ee2d5c50
AC
15299Reply:
15300@table @samp
15301@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15302@end table
15303
15304@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15305
8e04817f
AC
15306Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15307encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15308
15309Reply:
15310@table @samp
15311@item *
15312@end table
15313
8e04817f 15314See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15315
ee2d5c50
AC
15316@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15317
15318@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15319execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15320Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15321number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15322@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15323interpreter may have security implications}.
15324
15325Reply:
15326@table @samp
15327@item OK
8e04817f 15328A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15329@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15330A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15331@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15332Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15333@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15334When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15335@end table
15336
15337@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15338
8e04817f
AC
15339Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15340requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15341
15342Reply:
15343@table @samp
15344@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15345The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15346@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15347The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15348@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15349@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15350@end table
15351
15352@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15353
15354Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15355
15356@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15357target has previously requested.
15358
15359@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15360@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15361will be empty.
15362
15363Reply:
15364@table @samp
15365@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15366The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15367@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15368The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15369encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15370(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15371@end table
eb12ee30 15372
ee2d5c50
AC
15373@end table
15374
15375@node Register Packet Format
15376@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15377
8e04817f 15378The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15379In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15380sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15381to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15382byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15383most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15384
ee2d5c50 15385@table @r
eb12ee30 15386
8e04817f 15387@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15388
8e04817f
AC
15389All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1539032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15391registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15392
8e04817f 15393@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15394
8e04817f
AC
15395All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15396thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15397as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15398
ee2d5c50
AC
15399@end table
15400
15401@node Examples
15402@section Examples
eb12ee30 15403
8e04817f
AC
15404Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15405does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15406
474c8240 15407@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15408-> @code{R00}
15409<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15410@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15411-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15412<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15413<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15414-> @code{+}
474c8240 15415@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15416
8e04817f 15417Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15418
474c8240 15419@smallexample
d2c6833e 15420-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15421<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15422-> @code{s}
15423<- @code{+}
15424@emph{time passes}
15425<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15426-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15427-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15428<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15429<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15430-> @code{+}
474c8240 15431@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15432
aab4e0ec 15433@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15434
6826cf00
EZ
15435@include fdl.texi
15436
6d2ebf8b 15437@node Index
c906108c
SS
15438@unnumbered Index
15439
15440@printindex cp
15441
15442@tex
15443% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15444% meantime:
15445\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15446\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15447\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15448\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15449\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15450\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15451\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15452\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15453\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15454\page\colophon
15455% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15456@end tex
15457
c906108c 15458@bye